Sony Network Router BKS R1601 User Manual

ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM  
ROUTING SWITCHER  
RS-422A REMOTE ROUTING SWITCHER  
DVS-128 DVS-RS1616  
TIME CODE ROUTING SWITCHER  
DIGITAL AUDIO ROUTING SWITCHER  
DVS-TC3232  
DVS-A3232  
DIGITAL VIDEO ROUTING SWITCHER  
ANALOG AUDIO ROUTING SWITCHER  
DVS-V1616 BVS-A3232  
HD ROUTING SWITCHER  
ANALOG VIDEO ROUTING SWITCHER  
HDS-V3232 BVS-V3232  
DIGITAL VIDEO ROUTING SWITCHER  
DVS-V3232B/V3232M  
DVS-V6464B/V6464M  
MULTI BIT RATE ROUTING SWITCHER  
HDS-X3400/X3600/X3700  
16-SOURCE CONTROL UNIT  
MULTI DISPLAY CONTROL UNIT  
BKS-R1601  
BKS-R1607/R1617/R1621  
X-Y CONTROL UNIT  
BKS-R3202/R3210/R3220  
MULTI BUS CONTROL UNIT  
BKS-R3216  
32-SOURCE CONTROL UNIT  
BKS-R3203  
ROUTING SWITCHER CONTROLLER  
BKPF-R70/R70A  
UNIVERSAL CONTROL UNIT  
BKS-R3204/R1608/R3209  
BKS-R1618/R3219  
DIGITAL VIDEO 8 x 2 SELECTOR BOARD  
BKPF-300  
ANALOG VIDEO 8 x 2 SELECTOR BOARD  
BKPF-301  
SOURCE AND DESTINATION CONTROL UNIT  
BKS-R3205  
DIGITAL AUDIO 8 x 2 SELECTOR BOARD  
BKPF-350  
8-DESTINATION CONTROL UNIT  
BKS-R3206  
ANALOG AUDIO 8 x 2 SELECTOR BOARD  
BKPF-351  
INSTALLATION MANUAL FOR SYSTEM SETUP  
1st Edition (Revised 5)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Manual Structure  
Purpose of this manual .............................................................................................. 5  
Contents ..................................................................................................................... 5  
Related manuals......................................................................................................... 6  
DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series and DVS-V3232M/V6464M..................................... 8  
1. System Overview  
1-1. Digital Routing Switcher System ................................................................ 1-1  
1-2. System Control ............................................................................................ 1-3  
1-2-1. Specifications and functions of control port .............................. 1-3  
1-2-2. S-BUS control ............................................................................ 1-5  
1-2-3. 9-pin remote control ................................................................... 1-7  
1-2-4. Connection of control terminal .................................................. 1-9  
1-2-5. Control of monitor S-BUS system ............................................. 1-9  
2. Functions  
2-1. Main Functions of Router System............................................................... 2-1  
2-2. Built-in Controller ....................................................................................... 2-2  
2-3. Matrix Sizes ................................................................................................ 2-2  
2-4. Number of Levels........................................................................................ 2-2  
2-5. Number of Units.......................................................................................... 2-2  
2-6. Protect Function .......................................................................................... 2-3  
2-7. Secret Function............................................................................................ 2-3  
2-8. Crosspoint Disable Setting Function  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)............................. 2-3  
2-9. Password Function (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70, HDS-V3232) ... 2-3  
2-10. Setting the Input/Output Name  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)............................. 2-4  
2-11. Virtual Mapping Function  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)............................. 2-6  
2-12. Free Assignment Function  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)............................. 2-7  
2-13. Monitor Function (BKDS-V3292B only) ................................................... 2-8  
2-14. Tie Line Management  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)........................... 2-10  
2-15. Phantom Function .....................................................................................2-11  
2-16. Self-Diagnosis Function ............................................................................ 2-12  
2-17. Route Function .......................................................................................... 2-13  
2-18. Enhanced Restriction of Selected Block (BKS-R1607/R3210 only)........2-14  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Control Terminal  
3-1. Selecting the Control Terminal ................................................................... 3-1  
3-2. Control Terminal Display ........................................................................... 3-2  
3-3. System Status Screen .................................................................................. 3-3  
3-4. Menu Screen................................................................................................ 3-4  
3-4-1. Menu screen of the primary station............................................3-4  
3-4-2. Menu screen of the secondary station ........................................ 3-5  
3-4-3. Menu screen of the primary station on monitor S-BUS............. 3-9  
3-4-4. Menu screen of the secondary station on monitor S-BUS ......... 3-9  
3-5. Setting Screen............................................................................................ 3-11  
4. Setup Procedure  
4-1. Outline ......................................................................................................... 4-1  
4-2. Preliminary Information Before Installation ............................................... 4-2  
4-3. Preparation Before Setup ............................................................................ 4-3  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures ............................................................................... 4-4  
4-5. Flowchart of Setup .................................................................................... 4-24  
4-6. Setting Up BKPF-300/301/350/351 .......................................................... 4-25  
5. System Settings  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station ........................................................... 5-1  
A : DISPLAY CONTROL AREA ........................................................... 5-1  
A : DISPLAY UNIT LOCATION ........................................................... 5-1  
B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE ..............................................................5-2  
C : SET DESTINATION NAME ............................................................ 5-2  
D : SET SOURCE NAME ....................................................................... 5-4  
E : SET LEVEL TABLE ......................................................................... 5-6  
F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER ........................................................5-7  
G : UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER ............................................... 5-7  
H : SET GLOBAL PHANTOM............................................................... 5-8  
J : NAME STYLE ................................................................................ 5-10  
K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE ...................................................... 5-11  
K : DEFAULT TABLE.......................................................................... 5-11  
L : SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT ................................................... 5-11  
M : SET INHIBIT TABLE ..................................................................... 5-13  
N : SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP ............................................ 5-14  
O : SET TIE LINES ............................................................................... 5-16  
P : CHANGE PASSWORD .................................................................. 5-18  
Q : CHANGE CROSSPOINT................................................................ 5-18  
R : CALL SECONDARY STATION.................................................... 5-20  
S : SELECT INDICATION COLOR  
(Except for BKPF-R70, HDS-V3232) ............................................. 5-20  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
T : SET CLOCK .................................................................................... 5-20  
U : SELECT REMOTE..........................................................................5-21  
V : SELECT WARNING DISPLAY ..................................................... 5-22  
W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG................................................................. 5-23  
X : DISPLAY S-BUS COMMUNICATION......................................... 5-23  
Y : DISPLAY TABLE (Except for HDS-V3232) ................................. 5-24  
Z : SET UNIT DETECTABLE .............................................................5-24  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station ..................................................... 5-25  
A : SET UNIT LOCATION...................................................................5-25  
G : UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER ............................................. 5-26  
H : SET PHANTOM TABLE ................................................................ 5-27  
K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE ...................................................... 5-29  
K : DEFAULT TABLE..........................................................................5-29  
L : COPY TABLE DATA ..................................................................... 5-29  
M : SET MONITOR FUNCTION (Except for HDS-V3232) ................ 5-30  
N : SET PANEL TABLE (BKS-R1601/R3202/R3203) ........................ 5-30  
N : SET PANEL TABLE (BKS-R1607/R1608/R3204/R3205/R3209/  
R3210/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621) .................................... 5-31  
N : SET PANEL TABLE (BKS-R3206/R3216).................................... 5-32  
O : SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION (BKS-R3202/R3206) ............ 5-33  
O : SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION (BKS-R1607/R3210/R3216/  
R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621)............................................... 5-33  
R : SET ROUTE (BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210/R3216/R1617/  
R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621) .......................................................... 5-36  
S : DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME .................................................5-37  
U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL ................................................... 5-38  
V : DISPLAY UNIT STATUS (Except for HDS-V3232) ....................5-39  
Y : DISPLAY TABLE DATA (Except for HDS-V3232) ..................... 5-39  
Y : SET DISPLAY MODES (BKS-R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/  
R3220/R1621) .................................................................................. 5-40  
Z : SELECT SDI FORMAT (Except for HDS-V3232) ........................ 5-41  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS (BKS-R3204/R3205/R3206)...................... 5-42  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS (BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210/  
R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621) ................................... 5-43  
Z : SELECT CONNECTION (DVS-RS1616 only) .............................. 5-46  
Z : SWITCHING FIELD (HDS-V3232 only) ....................................... 5-46  
5-3. Setting Items of the Primary Station on Monitor S-BUS  
(BKDS-V3292B only) .............................................................................. 5-47  
F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER ...................................................... 5-47  
M : SELECT MONITOR FUNCTION ..................................................5-48  
R : CALL SECONDARY STATION.................................................... 5-48  
5-4. Setting Items of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS  
(BKDS-V3293B only) .............................................................................. 5-49  
M : SET AVAILABLE MONITOR LINE  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B + BKDS-R3292B) .................................... 5-49  
L : COPY TABLE DATA <MONITOR MENU> ................................5-49  
N : SET PANEL TABLE  
(BKS-R1607/R1608/R3204/R3205/R3209/R3210)  
<MONITOR MENU> ...................................................................... 5-50  
S : DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME <MONITOR MENU> ............ 5-51  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS  
(BKS-R1607/R1608/R3204/R3205/R3209/R3210)  
<MONITOR MENU> ...................................................................... 5-52  
5-5. Backup of Setting Data ............................................................................. 5-54  
5-6. When Data is Lost ..................................................................................... 5-54  
5-7. Initialization of Table Data ....................................................................... 5-55  
5-7-1. Initializing Procedure and Corresponding Items...................... 5-55  
5-7-2. Default Values Initialization .................................................... 5-56  
5-8. Signal Switching Timing........................................................................... 5-57  
6. Confirmation of function  
6-1. Outline ......................................................................................................... 6-1  
6-2. Function Check Format ............................................................................... 6-2  
6-3. How the Self-Diagnosis Items are Related ................................................. 6-3  
6-4. Diagnosis Items for Each Model ................................................................. 6-4  
6-5. Function Check Process .............................................................................. 6-5  
6-6. Function Check with Control Terminal ...................................................... 6-6  
6-6-1. System status screen after power on .......................................... 6-6  
6-6-2. System status screen during the system operation ..................... 6-7  
6-6-3. Menu item [W: SYSTEM STATUS LOG]................................6-7  
6-6-4. Contents and countermeasures of the error messages ................ 6-8  
7. Change Information on DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series  
and DVS-V3232M/V6464M  
7-1. Outline (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)...................................................... 7-1  
7-2. Changed Menu (Primary Station Setting Items) ......................................... 7-2  
Initial screen (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)........................................... 7-2  
A : DISPLAY CONTROL AREA (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series) ........7-3  
B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)........... 7-3  
E : SET LEVEL TABLE (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series) ...................... 7-4  
O : SET TIE LINES (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series) .............................. 7-4  
S : SET SOURCE ASSIGNMENT (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series) ...... 7-6  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items) ..................................... 7-6  
N : SET PANEL TABLE (HDS-X3400) ................................................. 7-6  
V : DISPLAY UNIT STATUS (DVS-128) ............................................. 7-7  
V : DISPLAY UNIT STATUS (HDS-X3000 Series) ............................. 7-8  
Z : SET SDI FORMAT (HDS-X3000 Series) ......................................... 7-9  
Z : SELECT SDI FORMAT (DVS-V3232M/DVS-V6464M).............. 7-11  
Appendix ......................................................................................................... A-1  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual Structure  
Purpose of this manual  
This is the Installation Manual (software) for the Sony routing switcher system (it is  
described as “router system” in this manual).  
It contains information on the initial settings of the software when installing the  
units making up the digital router system.  
This manual is intended for system and service engineers. But operators can also  
refer to it when setting and changing the system.  
This manual is supplied with the following switchers.  
DVS-V1616  
DVS-TC3232  
HDS-V3232  
DVS-V3232B  
DVS-A3232  
DVS-V3232M  
DVS-V6464B  
BVS-V3232  
DVS-V6464M  
DVS-RS1616  
BVS-A3232  
DVS-128  
BKPF-R70/R70A  
HDS-X3000 series (HDS-X3400/X3600/X3700)  
Refer to installation manual and/or maintenance manual supplied with each unit for  
information on installing the hardware.  
Contents  
The following is a summary of the sections for understanding the contents of this  
manual.  
1. System Overview  
This section outlines the basic structure of the digital router system and control  
mechanism using the S-BUS.  
2. Functions  
This section explains the main functions of the digital router system.  
3. Control Terminal  
This section explains the key operation and image display of the control terminal.  
Also describes how to use the personal computer as the control terminal.  
4. Setup Procedure  
This section explains the basic setting of DVS-V3232B/V6464B or HDS-V3232 as  
a primary station.  
5. System Settings  
This section explains the setting menus of the primary station and the secondary  
station and how to set each item in the menus, in detail.  
Also it explains how to backup the table data.  
6. Confirmation of Function  
This section explains the error messages and how to check the operations of the  
system after completing setting.  
7. Change Information on DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series and DVS-  
V3232M/V6464M  
Describes the change information accompanied with addition of functions and  
specification change.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Related manuals  
In addition to this installation manual for system setup, the following manuals are  
also available for the main units making up the system.  
(1) DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V3232M/V6464M/128  
. Operation Manual  
(supplied with the DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V3232M/V6464M/128)  
This manual explains the notes on operating, specifications, locations and  
functions.  
. Installation Manual (Hardware)  
(supplied with the DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V3232M/V6464M/128)  
This manual contains information on setting up the hardware when installing.  
. Maintenance Manual Part 1  
(supplied with the DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V3232M/V6464M/128)  
This manual contains information on the periodic maintenance and servicing  
information necessary for the principal block and board replacement.  
. Maintenance Manual Part 2  
(not supplied with the DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V3232M/V6464M/128)  
This manual contains detailed information on the maintenance and servicing and  
their parts (adjustment, board layout, schematic diagram, detailed parts list and so  
on).  
If this manual is required, please contact to Sony’s service organization.  
. Protocol Manual  
(not supplied with the DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V3232M/V6464M/128)  
This manual contains information on the protocols used for controlling the routing  
switcher system.  
The following manuals are available for protocols used to support.  
Please contact to Sony’s service organization to obtain a copy of the manual.  
S-BUS PROTOCOL AND COMMAND SPECIFICATIONS  
(S-BUS remote terminal control protocol)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM PROTOCOL AND SPECIFICATIONS  
(Sony cart protocol)  
. DVS-V3232B/V6464B Series Technical Manual*1  
(not supplied with the DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V3232M/V6464M/128)  
This manual contains technical outlines of a digital routing switcher system  
primary consisting of DVS-V3232B/V6464B information items.  
If this manual is required, please contact to Sony’s service organization.  
*1 : Common with DVS-V3232M/V6464M.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(2) DVS-V1616/A3232/RS1616/TC3232, BVS-V3232/A3232, BKS-R1607/  
R1608/R3209/R3210  
. Operation Manual (supplied with each unit)  
This manual explains the notes on operating, specifications, locations and  
functions of each unit.  
. Maintenance Manual (supplied with each unit)  
This manual contains information on the installation, maintenance, and servicing  
of the unit and its parts (replacement, block diagram, adjustment, board layout,  
schematic diagram, detailed parts list and so on).  
(3) BKS-R1601/R3202/R3203/R3204/R3205/R3206  
. Operation and Maintenance Manual (supplied with each unit)  
This manual contains information on the proper operation and application of the  
unit, installation, maintenance, and servicing of the unit and its parts (replace-  
ment, block diagram, adjustment, board layout, schematic diagram, detailed parts  
list and so on).  
(4) BKPF-R70/R70A, BKPF-300/301/350/351  
. Operation Manual (supplied with each unit)  
This manual explains the notes on operating, specifications, locations and  
functions of each unit.  
. Installation Manual (supplied with each unit)  
This manual contains information on setting up the hardware when installing each  
unit.  
. Maintenance Manual (not supplied with each unit)  
This manual contains detailed information on the maintenance and servicing of the  
unit and their parts (block diagram, adjustment, board layout, schematic diagram,  
detailed part list and so on).  
(5) HDS-V3232  
. Operation Manual (supplied with the HDS-V3232)  
This manual explains the notes on operating, specifications, locations and  
functions of each unit.  
. Maintenance Manual Part 1 (supplied with the HDS-V3232)  
This manual contains information on the periodic maintenance of HDS-V3232 and  
servicing information necessary for the principal block and board replacement.  
. Maintenance Manual Part 2 (not supplied with the HDS-V3232)  
This manual contains detailed information on the maintenance and servicing of  
HDS-V3232 and their parts (board layout, schematic diagram, detailed part list  
and so on).  
If this manual is required, please contact to Sony’s service organization.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(6) HDS-X3400/X3600/X3700  
. Maintenance Manual Part 1 (supplied with HDS-X3000 series)  
This manual describes how to install and maintain the HDS-X3000 series, and  
contains information on primary services (how to replace the main blocks and  
boards, and other information).  
. Maintenance Manual Part 2 (available on request)  
This manual describes the information that premises the service board parts  
replacement (board layouts, schematic diagrams and detailed parts list) of the  
HDS-X3000 series.  
If this manual is required, please contact your local Sony Sales Office/Service  
Center.  
(7) BKS-R3216/R1617/R3219  
. Operation Manual (supplied with each unit)  
This manual explains the notes on operating, specifications, locations and  
functions of each unit.  
. Maintenance Manual (available on request)  
This manual contains information on the maintenance and servicing of the unit  
and its parts (replacement, block diagram, adjustment, board layout, schematic  
diagram, detailed parts list and so on).  
DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series and DVS-V3232M/V6464M  
Because functions are added and specifications are changed in the DVS-128, there  
are several descriptions in section 1 to section 6 of this manual that do not agree  
with the DVS-128. Refer to “Change information on DVS-128/HDS-X3000 series  
and DVS-V3232M/V6464M” that is described in section 7 for the concrete change  
information of the DVS-128.  
For the contents of the DVS-V3232M/V6464M other than what are described above,  
please read the “DVS-V3232B/V6464B” for “DVS-V3232M/V6464M”.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1  
System Overview  
1-1. Digital Routing Switcher System  
The system consists of the following units.  
. Routing Switcher  
(DVS-V1616/V3232B/V6464B/A3232/TC3232/RS1616, BVS-V3232/A3232, HDS-V3232)  
It switches signals according to the command from the remote control unit. Varied switchers are  
available for different types of signals used (serial digital video, digital audio, time code, RS-422A,  
etc.)  
. Remote Control Unit  
(BKS-R1601/R3202/R3203/R3204/R3205/R3206/R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210/R3216/R1617/R3219/  
R3280/R3281)  
It switches signals and displays the name of the selected signal.  
. Control Terminal  
It sets the configuration and operation of the router system. It monitors the system in operation and  
displays the messages.  
A unique control protocol called S-BUS (Sony serial bus) is used for controlling the switcher system.  
With this protocol, all control signals are transmitted by using one 75 Z coaxial cable. The transmission  
path is called the “S-BUS data link”. Units on the S-BUS data links transmit data through time-divided  
bi-directional communication.  
Other than the S-BUS, the 9-pin remote control for RS-422A can also be used for this system. But the  
system will function best when the S-BUS control is used. For DVS-V3232B/V6464B and HDS-V3232,  
both protocols can be used together.  
With cascade connection, several sets of routing switchers of DVS-V6464B/V6464M can be connected  
together to expand the input/output matrix size. The inputs and outputs of DVS-V6464M can be expand-  
ed up to 1024.  
To operate this system, specified settings (making of table data) must be previously carried out using the  
control terminal.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-1. Digital Routing Switcher System  
Software Versions  
This manual is intended for systems consisting mainly of the DVS-V3232B/V6464B digital video routing  
switchers and units loading the following software versions and above.  
When units other than these are used, some terminal displays will be different and some functions cannot  
be used. Therefore, please contact to Sony’s service organization to upgrade the version of your software.  
n
Use the same version software for the same models of routing switcher or remote control units on the S-  
BUS data link. If different versions are used in one system, faults may occur.  
The software versions described in this manual are the following.  
. Digital video routing switcher DVS-V1616  
. Digital video routing switcher DVS-V3232B  
. Digital video routing switcher DVS-V6464B  
. Digital audio routing switcher DVS-A3232  
: V3.00  
: V2.10  
: V2.10  
: V3.00  
. RS-422A remote routing switcher DVS-RS1616 : V3.01  
. Time code routing switcher DVS-TC3232  
. Analog video routing switcher BVS-V3232  
. Analog audio routing switcher BVS-A3232  
: V3.01  
: V3.01  
: V3.01  
. HD digital video routing switcher HDS-V3232 : V2.10  
. 16-source control unit BKS-R1601  
. X Y control unit BKS-R3202  
. X Y control unit BKS-R3210  
. 32-source control unit BKS-R3203  
. Universal control unit BKS-R3204  
. Universal control unit BKS-R1608  
. Universal control unit BKS-R3209  
: V3.10  
: V3.10  
: V1.10  
: V3.10  
: V3.11  
: V1.10  
: V1.10  
. Source and destination control unit BKS-R3205 : V3.11  
. 8-destination control unit BKS-R3206  
. Multi display control unit BKS-R1607  
. Routing switcher controller BKS-R70  
. Digital video 8x2 selector board BKPF-300  
. Analog video 8x2 selector board BKPF-301  
. Digital audio 8x2 selector board BKPF-350  
. Analog audio 8x1 selector board BKPF-351  
: V3.11  
: V1.10  
: V1.01  
: V1.00  
: V1.00  
: V1.00  
: V1.00  
n
To install the single status display unit BKS-R3280/R3281, please refer to the operation and maintenance  
manual supplied with it.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
1-2. System Control  
1-2-1. Specifications and functions of control port  
The DVS-V3232B/V6464B and HDS-V3232 digital video routing switcher is equipped with four kinds of  
remote ports REMOTE 1 (S-BUS), REMOTE 2 (9-pin), REMOTE 3 (25-pin), and REMOTE 4 (monitor  
S-BUS). Other switchers are equipped with three kinds of remote ports excluding REMOTE 4.  
The specifications and functions of the control ports are as follows.  
REMOTE 1 BNC 75 Z 47 kZ terminated  
Protocol  
S-BUS control  
Data Transfer Method  
Data Transfer Speed  
Max Cable Length  
FCS Data  
BI-PHASE SPACE  
312.5 kbps/1250 kbps*1  
500 m/125 m*1 (BELDEN 8281 cable or equivalent)  
HDLC CRC-CCIT x + x + x + 1 Initial all high  
16  
12  
5
Function  
With this port the communication between the primary and secondary stations is performed.  
Remote control units, routing switchers and display units are connected to this S-BUS data  
link in order to perform system functions.  
REMOTE 1 is sometimes simply called “remote” for units having this remote port only.  
To distinguish the S-BUS using REMOTE 1 from the monitor S-BUS (REMOTE 4), which  
will be described later, it is called standard S-BUS or simply S-BUS.  
REMOTE 2 D-sub 9-pin  
Protocol  
RS-422A Flow control, 38.4 kbps, 100 Z /10 kZ  
This port accepts three kinds of protocols.  
Model  
Protocol  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V3232B  
HDS-V3232  
DVS-A3232  
DVS-RS1616  
DVS-TC3232  
BVS-V3232  
BVS-A3232  
DVS-V1616  
BKPF-R70  
CART PROTOCOL  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
AUDIO MIXER  
PROTOCOL *2  
Yes  
PRODUCTION SWITCHER  
PROTOCOL  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
Function  
With this port communication between two units is performed. A switcher, DME, etc. are  
connected to this port. The functions of the router system using this RS-422A port depend  
on a superior controller so that the system may not have so many functions as S-BUS  
system’s.  
*1: The specifications of BKPF-R70. When BKPF-R70 is used, termination resistors are necessary at both ends of the cable. The cable  
cannot be checked for open circuit.  
*2: Known before as switcher protocol.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
REMOTE 3 D-sub 25-pin (MODEM side pin arrangement)  
Protocol  
RS-232C, 9600 bps*1, 8bit, No Parity, No check  
Function  
With this port the communication between the primary station and the control terminal and  
the setting of the units are performed. It is recommended that the control terminal be always  
connected to the switcher set to the primary station, so that you can see error message of  
the communication circuit and operation condition of units.  
Although distorted displays may be shown when a terminal with low access speed is used,  
does not mean that the routing system has failed. In this case, replace the control terminal  
by one with high access speed. If not, it will be necessary to guess the contents of the  
display on the screen.  
REMOTE 4 BNC 75 Z 47 kZ terminated  
Protocol  
Function  
n
S-BUS control  
Data Transfer Method  
Data Transfer Speed  
Max Cable Length  
FCS Data  
BI-PHASE SPACE  
312.5 kbps  
500 m (BELDEN 8281 cable or equivalent)  
HDLC CRC-CCIT x + x + x +1 Initial all high  
16  
12  
5
Remote port for the monitor S-BUS. It forms a S-BUS data link, different from REMOTE  
1, and carries out communication between the primary and secondary stations for the  
monitor system (you cannot use this connector for the standard S-BUS). The data link  
consists of switchers, remote control units, display units, etc.  
To control the monitor S-BUS, the optional monitor board BKDS-V3292B is required.  
The protocols of REMOTE 2 are selected using the control terminal connected to REMOTE 3.  
*1: The transfer speed of BKPF-R70 is 38400 bps.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
1-2-2. S-BUS control  
The S-BUS control is a remote control system. It has a simple connection structure and provides highly  
efficient communication. Multiple routing switchers and remote control units are connected to a single  
bus line to form a control network called the S-BUS data link. The units on this S-BUS data link commu-  
nicate with each other using the S-BUS protocol, select the necessary data from the control data transmit-  
ted through the data link, and operate according to the data.  
The routing switchers on the S-BUS data link are designated to a primary station which controls the  
whole system (only one unit is set as this) and secondary stations. The primary station receives the  
instructions from the secondary stations and makes adjustments for smooth communication. It also  
constantly monitors the system and detects communication errors and problems. In addition to adjusting  
and controlling communication, the primary station also switch crosspoints as another switcher does.  
The S-BUS line is connected via the REMOTE 1 connector. Up to one line can be connected for BKPF-  
300/301/350/351, two lines for DVS-V1616, three lines for DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and  
HDS-V3232, and four lines for other switchers. Always terminate unused connectors with 75 Z.  
Features of S-BUS control system  
The main features of the S-BUS control are as follows.  
. LAN type control signal communication using one 75 Z coaxial cable (S-BUS line).  
. The coaxial cable can be extended to 500 m. (BELDEN 8281 cable or equivalent)  
. The primary station can control up to 254 units (including the primary station)*1 of routing switchers  
and remote control units using multiple S-BUS lines.  
. Up to 128 units of routing switchers and remote control units can be connected to one S-BUS line.  
Without stopping the system, the switchers and remote control units can be connected to the S-BUS  
line or removed from it.  
. The self-diagnosis results of the system can be monitored with the control terminal connected to the  
primary station.  
Basic configuration of S-BUS control  
S-BUS control is configured as follows.  
Name  
Equipment  
Quantity  
Function  
Primary station  
Routing switcher (M)*2  
1
Communication control in data link.  
Secondary station  
Remote control unit and routing  
switcher (S)*3  
253 max.  
Use data link in the time specified  
from the primary station.  
Control terminal  
software  
Personal computer with terminal  
1
Setting needed for system configuration  
and displaying the status.  
*1 : When one of the BKPF-300 series is set in a primary station, it can control up to 30 units (including the primary station).  
*2 : It means a switcher which is set the M/S switch on CPU board to “M” position. In the case of BKPF-R70, the switch is set to “P”  
position.  
*3 : It means a switcher which is set the M/S switch on CPU board to “S” position.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
Example of S-BUS control system connection  
: S-BUS  
Control  
: Signal Line  
: RS-232C  
Terminal  
Personal computer with a  
communication software or  
Windows 3.1 installed *1  
: T Bridge (A)  
: T Bridge (B)  
: 75 Z Terminator*3  
: Matrix Level  
Primary  
Station  
Level 1  
REMOTE 3  
Video Routing Switcher  
DVS-V64646B  
(M)*2  
<Video>  
Destination VTR  
<Audio Channel 1/2>  
<Audio Channel 3/4>  
<Time Code>  
Secondary  
Station  
Level 2  
Level 3  
Level 8  
Level 4  
Maximum  
253 units  
Audio Routing Switcher  
Audio Routing Switcher  
DVS-A3232  
Time Code  
Routing Switcher  
DVS-A3232  
(S)*2  
(S)*2  
Routing Switcher  
DVS-TC3232  
(S)*2  
(S)*2  
<Audio Channel 1/2>  
<Audio channel 3/4>  
Source  
VTR  
<Time Code>  
Display Unit  
BKS-R3280  
Level 1  
Level 1  
Display Unit  
BKS-R3281  
Video Routing Switcher  
DVS-V6464B  
(S)*2  
Video Routing Switcher  
DVS-V3232B  
(S)*2  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R1608  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R1607  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R3210  
Maximum  
128 unit  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R3209  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R3209  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R3209  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R3209  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R3209  
Remote Control Unit  
BKS-R3209  
Either one of the REMOTE 1 connectors of the secondary station routing switchers can be used.  
*1: The function switch will be not working in the terminal mode of the Windows 95/NT.  
*2: (M) and (S) mean the setting of M/S switch on the CPU board.  
*3: Connect the 75 Z terminators to the T type bridge of the last device on a S-BUS data link and to the unused REMOTE 1 connector.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
1-2-3. 9-pin remote control  
The Sony digital routing switcher can be controlled from external control units connected to the RE-  
MOTE 2 (D-sub 9-pin) using RS-422A. For DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232, the  
functions performed by 9-pin remote control, can especially be upgraded to a great extent. The following  
three kinds of 9-pin remote protocols can be used.  
. Sony production switcher protocol  
. Sony audio mixer protocol  
. Sony cart protocol  
n
The protocol that can be used depends on the models (refer to Section 1-2-1).  
BKPF-R70 is controlled by Sony cart protocol only.  
The DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232 can be switched between the “direct mode” in  
which they are controlled directly and to the “S-BUS conversion mode” in which cart protocol commands  
are converted to the S-BUS protocols.  
In the direct mode, the switchers can be controlled individually. In the S-BUS conversion mode, up to  
254 switchers on the S-BUS line (including the primary station) can be controlled.  
For DVS-V3232B/V6464B/V1616/A3232 and HDS-V3232, the S-BUS and 9-pin remote control lines  
are connected to REMOTE 1 and 2 respectively and can be switched freely. Other switchers can be  
connected to either control line.  
m
1. In the direct mode, the protect and secret functions set on the S-BUS protocol are not avail able.  
2. In the S-BUS conversion mode, the “UA2” data specified by the cart protocol will be converted to  
the level values on S-BUS protocol.  
In this mode, the protect and secret functions set on S-BUS protocol are available. (However, these  
functions cannot be set on the 9-pin remote control and the contents of the setting cannot be checked,  
either.)  
3. The number of input/output signals that can be controlled on each protocol is as follows.  
Protocol  
Control Area  
Cart Protocol*1  
Cart  
1-16  
Cart plus  
1-256  
Audio mixer protocol  
1-128  
1-127  
Production Switcher Protocol  
4. When several DVS-V6464Bs are connected in a cascade and the input bus number is in creased, if  
controlled by the 9-pin remote, there is the case no signal is output.  
To avoid such case, use the S-BUS conversion mode.  
*1 : There are two kinds of cart protocol due to the control area.  
Unless otherwise noted, “cart protocol” in this manual mean the cart plus protocol.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
The following is an example of a 9-pin remote control connection.  
System Console  
Main Controller  
Printer  
(Host CPU)  
Local disk  
Sub Controller  
(Interface Unit)  
Sub Controller  
(Interface Unit)  
RS-422A  
RS-422A  
Status Display  
Status Display  
Status Display  
Status Display  
Remote Control  
Unit  
Remote Control  
Unit  
Remote Control  
Unit  
Remote Control  
Unit  
Remote Control  
Unit  
Remote Control  
Unit  
Remote Control  
Unit  
Remote Control  
Unit  
REMOTE 1  
REMOTE 1  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-V3232B  
(M)  
DVS-V3232B  
(M)  
S-BUS  
S-BUS  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-  
V6464B  
(S)  
DVS-A3232  
(S)  
DVS-A3232 DVS-A3232  
(S)  
(S)  
DVS-A3232  
(S)  
DVS-A3232  
(S)  
DVS-A3232 DVS-A3232  
(S)  
(S)  
DVS-A3232  
(S)  
: S-BUS  
: RS-422A  
: 75 Z terminator  
: Standard units making up Sony router system  
(M) and (S) mean the setting of M/S switch on the CPU board.  
: T bridge  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
1-2-4. Connection of control terminal  
Connect the control terminal to the REMOTE3 (D-sub 25-pin) connector of the primary station as shown  
below. The control terminal is used for setting of the router system and for displaying the information of  
errors, problems, system status, etc. during operation.  
Use the personal computer installing the terminal software as the control terminal of the router system.  
DVS-V6464B  
Control terminal  
(IBM PC/AT compatibles)  
To D-sub 9-pin  
connector  
To REMOTE 3  
connector  
RS-232C cross cable (9-pin25-pin)  
n
REMOTE 3 connector of BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232 is D-sub 9-pin connector.  
When BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is set to the primary station, connect the control terminal to the unit by  
using the RS-232C cross cable.  
The control terminal is not able to connect to the system which primary station is set to BKPF-300 series.  
1-2-5. Control of monitor S-BUS system  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B is able to monitor all the input and output signals when the optional monitor  
board BKDS-V3292B is installed, whose CPU is used exclusively for monitoring. It forms a monitor S-  
BUS data link via the REMOTE4 connector.  
In this manual, the monitor control line is called “monitor S-BUS” to distinguish it from the control line  
of the main S-BUS using for changing crosspoints. The main S-BUS is called “standard S-BUS” or  
simply “S-BUS”. Excluding the system control, the monitor S-BUS has exactly the same protocol and  
communication format as that of the standard S-BUS.  
The input monitor and output monitor can be either used separately or combined. They can be also  
connected in cascade. As the crosspoint control of the monitor is performed separately from the standard  
S-BUS control system, a primary station for the monitor S-BUS must be designated in addition to that set  
for the standard S-BUS.  
The configuration of the monitor S-BUS is set with the control terminal connected to the primary station  
on the standard S-BUS.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2. System Control  
The following shows one way of connecting the monitor S-BUS system.  
<S-BUS>  
Secondary  
Station (S)  
Primary  
Station (M)  
B type  
A type  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
(Max.  
200 m)  
(Inut signal)  
Monitor  
(Max. 200 m)  
Secondary  
Station (S)  
Secondary  
Station (S)  
D type  
C type  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
(Max.  
200 m)  
(Output/Input signal)  
(Max. 200 m)  
Monitor  
BKS-R3209  
(M) (S)  
: M/S switch setting on the monitor Board.  
: T Bridge (A)  
BKS-R3209  
BKS-R3209  
BKS-R3210  
: T Bridge (B)  
: 75 Z Terminator  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
1-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2  
Functions  
2-1. Main Functions of Router System  
1) The routing switcher is equipped with a system controller. It therefore does not require an  
additional controller for controlling the routing switchers.  
2) By the cascade connection, up to 512 x 512 crosspoints can be selected.  
3) Up to 8 levels can be assigned.  
4) Up to 254 units can be controlled in a system.  
5) Each output signal can be protected so that they will not be switched by other control units.  
(Protect function)  
6) Each input signal can be prohibited to be selected from all the control units. (Secret function)  
7) The inputs that can be selected for each output can be limited. (Crosspoint disable setting  
function)  
*
*
*
*
*
8) Password function  
9) The either name of “Type + Number” or “Description” can be set for input/output connectors.  
10) A crosspoint matrix can be mapped on a virtual matrix. (Virtual mapping function)  
11) To each connector name, a different connector number can be assigned on each level.  
(Free assignment function)  
*
*
12) Input and output signals can be monitored using the optional monitor board BKDS-V3292B.  
(Monitoring function)  
13) You can enable the system to automatically select the signal lines between two routing switchers.  
(Tie line function)  
14) You can simultaneously switch several crosspoints. (Phantom function)  
15) The control terminal connected to the primary station will display the system status informations  
and error messages. (Self-diagnosis function)  
16) When DVS-7000 is connected to the destination of DVS-V3232B/V6464B, the source name of  
the routing switcher is indicated on the DVS-7000. (Route function)  
17) BKS-R1607 and BKS-R3210 can restrict the crosspoint block of selection for each remote  
control unit.  
* : DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232 only (BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232 has no monitor function described  
“12”).  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232 outstanding offers new functions as a primary  
station. To get the best out of the system, we recommend that DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or  
HDS-V3232 is used as a primary station.  
BKPF-R70 switches the crosspoint at a highest speed in the four switchers by mounted RISC CPU.  
The following outlines each function. (For details of how to set them, refer to the Section 5 “System  
Settings”.)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-2. Built-in Controller  
2-3. Matrix Sizes  
2-4. Number of Levels  
2-5. Number of Units  
2-2. Built-in Controller  
The Sony digital routing switcher incorporates a system controller and therefore does not require a  
separate external controller. When several routing switchers are connected to the S-BUS, the CPU of the  
switcher set as the primary station will control the whole system.  
2-3. Matrix Sizes  
By the cascade connection, input and output signals can be expanded to form a large-scale of router  
system.  
Maximum matrix sizes depend on the kind of switchers.  
. DVS-V6464B : 512 inputs x 512 outputs  
. DVS-A3232 : 256 inputs x 256 outputs  
. DVS-TC3232 : 256 inputs x 256 outputs  
. DVS-RS1616 : 128 inputs x 128 outputs (at 16 mode)  
256 inputs x 256 outputs (at 32 mode)  
. BKPF-300/350 : 112 inputs x 2 outputs  
. BKPF-301/351 : 32 inputs x 2 outputs (BKPF-301), 1 output (BKPF-351)  
n
DVS-V1616/V3232B, HDS-V3232 and BVS-V3232/A3232 are not able to connect by the cascade.  
2-4. Number of Levels  
The router system has the capability to control the different types of signal at the same time. This is  
enabled by the level setting.  
The router system can handle the signals such as video, audio, timecode and the RS-422A remote control  
signal. These signals are switched by their exclusive switchers. The signals that perform switching are  
allocated in the different layers. These layers are called levels.  
In the router system, the different numbers are given to the input and output signals of the respective  
layers that enable switching of various signals at the different levels simultaneously.  
Example: Video can be set to level 1, audio to level 2, etc.  
Up to eight levels can be set for one system.  
The levels are set in the menu item [E : SET LEVEL TABLE].  
2-5. Number of Units  
Up to 128 remote control units and switchers can be connected to one S-BUS line. It is possible to  
control up to 254 units (including the primary station) in total of all lines.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-6. Protect Function  
2-7. Secret Function  
2-8. Crosspoint Disable Setting Function (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
2-9. Password Function (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
2-6. Protect Function  
Function which protects the crosspoint set so that it cannot be released using other remote control units.  
While the protect function is on, the destination of the crosspoint to be protected will be fixed. Once the  
protect is set, it will not be released by any command, except those from the control terminal and the  
control unit used to set it. The protect function can be set and released freely from the control terminal  
connected to the primary station.  
The control terminal also has a password function which allows only certain users to operate the system.  
The protect function can be set in the menu item [C: SET DESTINATION NAME].  
2-7. Secret Function  
Function which “hides” certain sources from all control units to protect the crosspoint set so that it cannot  
be switched.  
Unlike the protect function that limits the destinations, the secret function limits the sources to protect  
them from being selected by other control units.  
The secret function can be set in the menu item [D: SET SOURCE NAME].  
2-8. Crosspoint Disable Setting Function (DVS-V3232B/V6464B,  
BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
Function that limits the sources that can be selected for each destination. It can also be used to fix the area  
of crosspoints selected so that only certain sources can be selected for certain destinations. This function  
can be only used when a DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is assigned as the primary  
station.  
This function can be set in the menu item [M: SET INHIBIT TABLE].  
2-9. Password Function  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
The control terminal can set all configuration items of the routing switcher system. It therefore has a  
password function which allows only certain users to operate it. The password can be set in the menu item  
[P: CHANGE PASSWORD].  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-10. Setting the Input/Output Name (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
2-10. Setting the Input/Output Name  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
The following names can be used for the input/output connectors of the routing switcher.  
1. “Type+Number” name  
2. ”Description“ name  
There are altogether three kinds of numbers that can be set as input/output numbers. These are “physical  
number”, “connector number”, and “virtual number”.  
The physical number and connector number are the number of connectors attached to the switcher. For a  
DVS-V6464B, it is 1 to 64. For a DVS-V3232B, it is 1 to 32. The difference between the physical  
number and connector number is that the connector number is used for each switcher frame, while the  
physical number is used for one router system that is either single frame or multiple cascading frames.  
Usually the physical number is used for the S-BUS control system, while the connector number is used  
for the RS-422A (9-pin remote) control system.  
The virtual number is the numbers assigned when switchers are mapped on a virtual matrix with 512  
inputs and 512 outputs. The numbers will not duplicate even if several switchers are mapped on the  
virtual matrix. Unless otherwise noted, the input/output number in this manual means the virtual number.  
INPUT  
Virtual number  
152  
88  
25  
18  
9
1
1
DVS-V1616  
(LEVEL-1)  
5
DVS-V1616  
(LEVEL-8)  
10  
12  
OUTPUT  
Physical number  
128  
(64)  
65 64  
1
(Connector number)  
(1) (64)  
(1)  
1
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
(64) 64  
75  
(Connector number)  
Physical number  
Virtual number  
Virtual Matrix  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-10. Setting the Input/Output Name (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
The name “Type + Num” consists of four alphabets and three numbers. It is assigned to the virtual  
number. Sixteen kinds of letters can be set for the “Type” part. Number 1 to 999 can be used for the  
“Num” part.  
Examples: CAM 234, VTR 145  
The name “Description” consists of any 16 characters and is assigned to the virtual number, e.g. “Tokyo”  
and “Market”. Up to 1024 kinds of names can be registered. The 160 kinds of them are transmitted to the  
remote control unit in order to set buttons and for displaying. The 160 names can be registered as one  
group. Data of 8 groups can be registered at the primary station. The data of remote control unit can be  
replaced by a group and the different data groups can be used for each remote control unit  
Primary station (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, HDS-V3232)  
Remote control unit  
8 groups  
No. 2 group  
No. 1  
No. 2  
No. 3  
No. 4  
1 group for  
each unit  
No. 2 group  
No. 4 group  
No. 8  
1group : 160 names  
Description Name  
The name “Description” can be selected the “DESCRIP. NAME” in the menu item [J: NAME STYLE]  
when a DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is used as the primary station.  
After the selection, set the description name in the menu item [C : SET DESTINATION NAME] or [D :  
SET SOURCE NAME].  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-11. Virtual Mapping Function (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
2-11. Virtual Mapping Function  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
Several routing switchers can be mapped on a virtual matrix with 512 inputs and 512 outputs in router  
system. The matrix of one switcher can be also divided into several virtual levels and mapped.  
For example, a switcher handling the 4:2:2 video signal and a switcher handling the 4 fsc video signal can  
be mapped on the same level. By connecting them using a 4:2:2/4 fsc converter, the tie line control can be  
performed (refer to Section 2-14).  
DVS-A3232 has two modes such as 2-channel mode and 4-channel mode. Normally, either one will be  
selected. However it is possible to use the overlapping area as the 4-channel mode by dividing the matrix  
into two in the 2-channel mode and assigning them to the different virtual levels.  
In the figure below, the 12 x 12 area where the level 2 and level 3 is overlapping is set to the 4 -channel  
mode while the other is set to the 2-channel mode in the 20 x 20 area.  
DVS-A3232  
(2-channel mode)  
12  
1
1
Mapping to LEVEL-2 (1 to 20)  
LEVEL-3  
32  
20  
12  
1
(AUDIO-2)  
1
20  
12  
1
12  
1
LEVEL-2  
(AUDIO-1)  
12  
20  
12  
20  
32  
Mapping to LEVEL-3 (1 to 12)  
: 2-channel mode  
: 4-channel mode  
It is called “Virtual mapping” that you assign crosspoints using the virtual matrices and virtual levels in  
this way.  
This virtual mapping function can be set in the menu item [L: SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT] when a  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is used as the primary station.  
n
When the matrix of a DVS-V3232B/V6464B is divided into two or more matrices on multiple virtual  
levels, the monitor function for input/output signals may not work correctly.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-12. Free Assignment Function (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
2-12. Free Assignment Function  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
While the same input/output number can be assigned, through levels 1 to 8, for each input/output name,  
different physical number can also be assigned on each level for an input/output name.  
The following figure shows the case that DVS-V6464B is used for level 1 and DVS-A3232 for levels 2 and  
3. To source IN002, physical number 5 can be assigned on level 1, physical number 2 on level 2, and  
physical number 18 on level 3.  
Similarly, to destination OUT004, physical number 32 can be assigned on level 1, physical number 32 on  
level 2, and physical number 4 on level 3.  
18  
LEVEL-3  
(AUDIO-2)  
LEVEL-2  
(AUDIO-1)  
2
4
32  
5
LEVEL-1  
(VIDEO)  
32  
IN002  
32  
OUT004  
This free assignment function can be set in the menu item [L: SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT] when a  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is used as the primary station.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-13. Monitor Function (BKDS-V3292B only)  
2-13. Monitor Function (BKDS-V3292B only)  
If a DVS-V3232B/V6464B is equipped with the optional BKDS-V3292B, any input/output signal can be  
monitored. The input and output signals can be observed on different monitors or on the same monitor by  
switching channels.  
By connecting the monitor signals of several switchers in cascade form, all input and output signals can be  
observed on one monitor.  
The crosspoints of monitor signals are controlled by the monitor S-BUS (the control line similar to the  
standard S-BUS although it controls only the monitor system).  
The primary station on the monitor S-BUS is independent from the primary station on the standard S-BUS.  
Therefore, several monitor S-BUS can be set to one system.  
For example, switchers (P-2) and (P-3) in the figure on next page serve as the primary station on the  
monitor S-BUS independently, while the switcher (P-1) serves as the primary station on the standard S-  
BUS and monitor S-BUS.  
Input  
Input  
1
(Input) 128  
65  
64  
1
Input Monitor  
(Separate connection)  
Output  
DVS-V6464B  
(B Type)  
DVS-V6464B  
(A Type)  
64  
65  
Output  
DVS-V6464B  
(D Type)  
DVS-V6464B  
(C Type )  
128  
(Output)  
Output Monitor (Separate connection)  
or  
Input + Output Monitor (Combined connection)  
m
1. For DVS-V3232B/V6464B routing system, the primary station on the standard S-BUS and monitor S-  
BUS should be the same.  
However, for the monitor S-BUS which does not include the primary station on the standard S-BUS,  
any switcher can be assigned the primary station.  
2. BKS-R1601/R3203/R3206 cannot be used as a secondary station on the monitor S-BUS.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-13. Monitor Function (BKDS-V3292B only)  
BKS-R3204  
BKS-R3204  
BKS-R3204  
BKS-R3206  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
(P-1)  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
75 Z  
Terminate  
75 Z  
Terminate  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
(P-2)  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
75 Z  
Terminate  
75 Z  
Terminate  
BKS-R3204  
: Standard S-BUS Line  
: Monitor S-BUS Line  
DVS-V6464B  
BKS-R3204  
(P-3)  
75 Z Terminate  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-14. Tie Line Management (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
2-14. Tie Line Management  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
If the primary station is a DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232, by previously setting four  
signal paths between routing switchers, unused signal paths can be selected automatically and protected  
when input and output names are selected. This function is called tie line management. It is effective to  
share the minimum number of converters (4:2:2:/4 fsc, 4 fsc/4:2:2, etc.).  
For example, if both a 4:2:2 video switcher and a 4 fsc video switcher have 32 sources and destinations,  
the converters can be shared using the tie line function and all sources and destinations can be handled  
with the minimum number of converters.  
Converter  
Net group  
Source group  
Converter  
Net group  
Routing Switcher  
(4 : 2 : 2)  
Routing Switcher  
(4 fsc)  
Destination group  
Setting Procedure of the Tie Line  
1. Set four input/output for each source/destination*1 group.  
2. Set the four cables connecting the switchers for each net groups such as “OUT * * * _ IN * * *”.  
3. Set the path from the source group to the destination (the path consists of the selected group names)  
*1 : Source means the input signal. Destination means the output signal.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-14. Tie Line Management (DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
Operation example:  
1. IN023 and OUT027 are selected from the remote control unit.  
2. The CPU of the primary station detects IN023 from the source group. In the example below, the  
corresponding group is S002.  
3. Like for IN023, the CPU also detects OUT027. The corresponding group is D002.  
4. The CPU of a primary station detects the path which has the S002 and D002 groups. In the following  
example, the corresponding path is “3: S002-N004-D002”.  
5. As N004 will be detected as the net group to be used, the CPU selects a usable element (not protect-  
ed) from the four “OUT-IN” elements set in the N004 group, and the crosspoint is switched.  
In the following example, if OUT033-IN230 is usable, the path IN023OUT033IN230OUT027  
will be selected.  
SOURCE GROUPS NET GROUPS  
DESTINATION GROUPS  
D001:OUT023  
OUT024  
S001:IN003  
IN004  
N001:OUT003-IN200  
N002:OUT013-IN054  
OUT014-IN055  
OUT004-IN201  
OUT005-IN202  
OUT006-IN203  
IN005  
OUT015-IN056  
OUT025  
IN006  
OUT016-IN057  
OUT026  
S002:IN010  
IN015  
N003:OUT023-IN007  
OUT024-IN008  
N004:OUT033-IN230  
OUT034-IN231  
OUT035-IN233  
OUT036-IN234  
:
D002:OUT027  
OUT028  
IN023  
OUT025-IN009  
OUT029  
IN027  
OUT026-IN010  
OUT030  
:
:
( 20 groups )  
( 40 groups )  
( 20 groups )  
PATHS  
1:S001-N001-N002-D001  
2:S002-N003-D001  
3:S002-N004-D002  
:
( 20 paths )  
2-15. Phantom Function  
Several crosspoints can be switched simultaneously with just one push of a button of the remote control  
unit. This is called the phantom function.  
The phantom function is set using the control terminal connected to the primary station. The crosspoints  
are switched by the remote control unit.  
The group of crosspoints switched together is called the phantom group. Each remote control unit stores  
the data of 57 crosspoints as the phantom group. In addition to the phantom function, in DVS-V3232B/  
V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232, the data of 4095 crosspoints is stored in the primary station as the  
other kind of phantom groups. In this manual, the registered phantoms in each remote control unit are  
referred to as “local phantom”. Those registered in the primary station are referred to as “global phan-  
tom”.  
The global phantom function is available if a DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is used  
as the primary station.  
n
The BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210 have the local phantoms of the destination offset type in addition  
to the ordinary local phantom, that support the various switching.  
Refer to the operation manual supplied with equipment for more details.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-16. Self-Diagnosis Function  
2-16. Self-Diagnosis Function  
The routing switcher performed self-diagnosis on the following items and displays the results on the  
control terminal connected to the primary station.  
O Presence of board and its sort  
O Version of ROM on the control board  
O Presence of backup power supply unit/backup CPU board  
O Detection of fan rotation  
O Display of reference signal  
O Display of errors as follows  
. Faulty crosspoint (hardware)  
. Display of high temperature  
. Display of S-BUS disconnection  
. Display of required secondary station’s disconnection or fault  
. Display of backup unit (control board or power supply unit)’s fault/recovery.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-17. Route Function  
2-17. Route Function  
One of an application of Router is to expand number of Source inputs for DVS-7000 connecting with  
DVS-V6464B, show below.  
Route function is to display a source input chasing from a last program out even performing 4 times Re-  
entry function with DVS-7000/DME. To display the actually selected source name, you must set the  
route function with the control terminal. Then when you select the crosspoint set on the route function,  
the source on the switcher A is searched for and the name is displayed. For example, when a crosspoint is  
switched on the switcher A in the figure below, normally IN5 appears as the source name. If the route  
function has been set, the source name selected on switcher A appears.  
To activate the route function, set the destination of switcher A, destination and source of switcher B, and  
level. In case of the figure below, set “OUT1 : OUT2 < IN5.”  
When you use the route function, switching is possible with simple setting. For example if you select a  
source (IN1) for a destination (OUT1) on switcher A , the crosspoint on switcher B (IN5-OUT2) is  
automatically switched.  
On the other hand, when you select a source (IN1) for a destination (OUT2) on switcher A, you have to  
set a phantom, IN1 : OUT1 < IN1 previously. Then IN1-OUT2 is displayed if the phantom; IN1 is  
selected.  
(Source of switcher A)  
1
2
3
4
IN  
(Destination of switcher A)  
OUT1  
Expanded input (Source of swithcer B)  
(Destination of  
IN  
5
6
7
8
switcher B)  
OUT2  
DVS-V6464B (Level 1)  
Switcher A  
DVS-7000 (Level 1)  
Switcher B  
OUT2 controlling panel  
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
Expanded input selection buttons  
Selection buttons  
Phantoms are set to these button.  
IN1 : OUT1 < IN1  
IN2 : OUT1 < IN2  
IN3 : OUT1 < IN3  
IN4 : OUT1 < IN4  
As OUT1 is included in switching setup data,  
OUT2 < IN5 is switched automatically by Route function.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-18. Enhanced Restriction of Selected Block (BKS-R1607/R3210 only)  
2-18. Enhanced Restriction of Selected Block (BKS-R1607/R3210 only)  
If you define a certain number of outputs, you can vary a number of inputs which would not be capable  
with the older panel.  
This is applicable with BKS-R1607 and BKS-R3210.  
Maximum 8 blocks can be defined.  
Block  
Selected block of input  
1 to 64  
Selected block of output  
1 to 64  
1
2
101 to 164  
101 to 132  
512  
164  
101  
64  
1
Block 1  
(DVS-V6464B)  
64  
101  
Block 2  
(DVS-V6464B)  
132  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3  
Control Terminal  
3-1. Selecting the Control Terminal  
Load Windows 3.1 to an IBM PC/AT compatible machine (CPU: 80486 or a faster and more powerful  
micro-processor, clock: 25 MHz or faster enough) and use it as a control terminal in the terminal mode of  
Windows.  
When using personal computers, codes F1 to F5 must be set to the Windows screen.  
Key Name  
Command  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
_
^ [ [ 17 ~  
^ [ [ 18 ~  
^ [ [ 19 ~  
^ [ [ 20 ~  
^ [ [ 21 ~  
_
_
_
_
_
*
It is possible to select codes F1 to F5 by using the cursor keys or using the [Ctrl] _ [Alt] _ [F||] key  
combination.  
Connect the personal computer to the primary routing switcher (REMOTE 3) using the RS-232C cable.  
Symbols Used in This Manual  
The symbols used for the control terminal keys in this manual are as follows.  
(1) All keys are enclosed in boxes. (Ex. [Ctrl], [Return])  
(2) The numerical keys in the text mean keys [0] to [9].  
(3) The alphabet keys in the text mean keys [A] to [Z].  
(4) The cursor key in the text mean the [(], [)], [&], and [*] keys.  
(5) When two keys are to be pressed together, they are joined by the “_”. (Ex. [Ctrl] _ [X])  
Functions of Keys Used for Setting  
Character key : Insert the character pressed where the cursor is.  
[*]  
[&]  
: Move the cursor to the right one space.  
: Move the cursor to the left one space.  
[Ctrl] _ [L] : Move the cursor to the right end of the character string.  
[Ctrl] _ [A] : Move the cursor to the left end of the character string.  
[Ctrl] _ [X] : Erase the whole character string being input and moves the cursor to the left end.  
[BS]  
: Erase the character just before the cursor.  
[DEL]  
: Erase the character at the cursor.  
[Ctrl] _ [U] : Recover the characters erased with [BS] or [DEL] where the cursor is (up to 16 charac-  
ters can be restored).  
[Ctrl] _ [F] : Erase the character string input and recover the original state.  
[Enter]  
: Fix the entered command and data (same as [Return]).  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-2. Control Terminal Display  
3-2. Control Terminal Display  
The control terminal display consists of the following three types of screen.  
. System status screen : It displays messages while the router system is operating.  
. Menu screen :  
It displays the menu for setting the router system.  
. Setting screen :  
It displays the setting items of each menu.  
System Status Screen  
Monitor S-BUS Menu  
and Setting Screen  
[Ctrl] - [D]  
[Ctrl] - [X]  
[Ctrl] - [X]  
*2  
*3  
Menu Screen  
Menu Screen  
[Ctrl] - [D]  
*1  
*1  
[Ctrl] - [E]  
[Ctrl] - [E]  
[Ctrl] - [E]  
Setting Screen  
Setting Screen  
Setting of the primary station  
Setting of the Secondary station  
*2  
Menu Screen  
Menu Screen  
[Ctrl] - [Z]  
*1  
*1  
[Ctrl] - [E]  
[Ctrl] - [E]  
Setting Screen  
Setting Screen  
Setting of the secondary station on  
monitor S-BUS  
Setting of the primary station on  
monitor S-BUS  
*1 : The menu items can be selected in the following two ways.  
1. Select the desirable menu item using the cursor keys, and press [Enter].  
2. Press the alphabet key allocated to each menu item.  
*2 : To move from the menu screen of the primary station to that of the secondary station, execute the  
menu item [R: CALL SECONDARY STATION] of the primary station.  
*3 : To move onto the menu of the primary station on the monitor S-BUS, execute the menu item [M:  
SET MONITOR FUNCTION] of the secondary station (set as the primary station on the monitor S-  
BUS).  
n
Monitor function is able to work by BKDS-V3292B only.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-3. System Status Screen  
3-3. System Status Screen  
When the primary station is turned ON, the results of the self-diagnosis and ROM check sum value are  
displayed as shown below.  
If the result of the self-diagnosis is satisfactory, “OK” will be displayed at the corresponding item.  
However if an error has been detected, this item will be the reversal characters.  
Model  
Software version  
SONY Digital Routing System DVS-V6464B V2.10  
ITEM  
ROM CHECK SUM  
8A65  
OK  
RAM READ AND WRITE  
REFERENCE SIGNAL  
S-BUS LINK TERMINATE  
REAL TIME CLOCK  
OK  
OK  
STARTED  
1993.02.03-22.15 STARTED BY DVS-V6464B Ver2.10 IN STATION 1  
1993.02.03-22.15 S-BUS LINK DISCONNECTED TO CHANNEL B  
1993.02.03-22.15 MISSING REFERENCE SIGNAL IN STATION 1  
1993.02.03-22.15 POWER SUPPLY UNIT B DOWN IN STATION 1  
System Status Screen  
When a message is output to the S-BUS data link, the system status screen will also show the time and  
data of the event along with the message.  
1990.10.12-15:42 S-BUS LINK DISCONNECTED  
1990.10.27-09:28 STARTED BY BKS-R1601 Ver3.10 IN STATION 11  
1990.11.03-05:31 STARTED BY BKS-R3204 Ver3.11 IN STATION 32  
1991.01.14-13:51 MISSING REFERENCE SIGNAL IN STATION 1  
1991.02.01-11:15 POWER SUPPLY UNIT B DOWN IN STATION 4  
1991.02.04-06:11 X-POINT ERROR IN STATION 1  
Messages of the System Status  
If some error or event happens while you open a Menu Screen or a Setting Screen, then the message will  
be displayed when you open the system status screen.  
The display will change to the menu screen when [Ctrl] _ [X] is pressed.  
To return to the system status screen, press [Ctrl] _ [X] again.  
n
When [Ctrl] _ [X] is pressed, the menu screen will be opened.  
At this time, if the password is required, input the password.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4. Menu Screen  
3-4. Menu Screen  
3-4-1. Menu screen of the primary station  
The menu screen shows all menu items for system setting in the table data of the primary station.  
By selecting the items on the menu screen using the following procedure, the screen will show the setting  
screen.  
n
Compared with the system status screen, router system operations take more time, when the menu screen  
or the setting screen is open. Therefore, please return to the system status screen after system setting.  
The following are two methods of selecting the menu items.  
1. Use the cursor keys to select the desired menu item, and press [Enter]. (Some models have no this  
function. In this case, perform step 2. to select.)  
2. Press the alphabet key assigned to each menu item.  
The screen will return to the system status screen when [Ctrl] _ [X] pressed.  
Primary station menu screen of DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is as follows.  
Model  
Software version  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
Station address  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
A: DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
C: SET DESTINATION NAME  
E: SET LEVEL TABLE  
B: SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE  
D: SET SOURCE NAME  
F: SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
H: SET GLOBAL PHANTOM  
K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
M: SET INHIBIT TABLE  
O: SET TIE LINES  
G: UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
J: NAME STYLE(Type + Num)  
L: SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT  
N: SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP  
P: CHANGE PASSWORD  
Menu item  
Q: CHANGE CROSSPOINT  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
MAINTENANCE COMMAND  
S: SELECT INDICATION COLOR(OFF) T: SET CLOCK  
U: SELECT CONTROL MODE  
W: SYSTEM STATUS LOG  
Y: DISPLAY TABLE DATA  
V: SELECT WARNING DISPLAY (ON)  
X: DISPLAY S-BUS COMMUNICATION  
Z: SET UNIT DETECTABLE  
Short-cut key  
Ctrl-X:QUIT SETUP MENU  
Menu Screen of the Primary Station (Ex. DVS-V6464B)  
n
. Menu screen of BKDF-R70 does not have the menu item [S].  
. Menu screen of HDS-V3232 does not have the menu item [S] and [Y].  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4. Menu Screen  
3-4-2. Menu screen of the secondary station  
To call the menu screen of the secondary station, select menu item [R: CALL SECONDARY STATION]  
in the primary station menu and input the secondary station number.  
To set the secondary station function of the routing switcher used as the primary station, input “1” as the  
secondary station number.  
The screen will return to the menu screen of the primary station when [Ctrl] _ [D] is pressed.  
n
When the secondary station menu is called, the color function will become ineffective, even if [S: SE-  
LECT INDICATION COLOR] has been selected to “ON”.  
(1) Routing switcher  
1 DVS-V1616  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
DVS-V1616 V3.00 STATION NUMBER 9  
K: DEFAULT TABLE  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
A: SET UNIT LOCATION  
MAINTENANCE COMMAND  
Y: DISPLAY TABLE  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station (Ex. DVS-V1616)  
2 DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 2  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
A: SET UNIT LOCATION  
G: UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
M: SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
U: SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL  
MAINTENANCE COMMAND  
Y: DISPLAY TABLE DATA  
V: DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
Z: SELECT SDI FORMAT  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station (Ex. DVS-V6464B)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4. Menu Screen  
3 DVS-RS1616/TC3232/A3232, BVS-V3232/A3232  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
DVS-RS1616 V3.01 STATION NUMBER 7  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
A: SET UNIT LOCATION  
K: DEFAULT TABLE  
G: UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
MAINTENANCE COMMAND  
Z: SELECT CONNECTION  
Y: DISPLAY TABLE  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station (Ex. DVS-RS1616)  
n
DVS-TC3232/A3232 and BVS-V3232/A3232 does not have menu item [Z].  
4 HDS-V3232  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
HDS-V3232 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 3  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
A: SET UNIT LOCATION  
K: DEFAULT TABLE  
G: UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
U: SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL  
MAINTENANCE COMMAND  
Z: SWITCHING FIELD  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station (Ex. HDS-V3232)  
5 BKPF-R300/301/350/351  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SOURCE No. 0001-0008  
BKPF-300 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 13  
DESTINATION No: 0001 LEVEL No.: 1  
SWITCHING FIELD: ASYNC SDI FORMAT: 4:2:2  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station (Ex. BKPF-R300)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4. Menu Screen  
(2) Remote control unit  
1 BKS-R3202  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3202 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 16  
MODEFICATION COMMAND  
H: SET PHANTOM TABLE  
N: SET PANEL TABLE  
O: SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION  
L: COPY TABLE DATA  
S: DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Remote Control Unit (Ex. BKS-R3202)  
2 BKS-R3204/R3205/R3206  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
MODEFICATION COMMAND  
H: SET PHANTOM TABLE  
BKS-R3206 V3.11 STATION NUMBER 18  
N: SET PANEL TABLE  
O: SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION  
L: COPY TABLE DATA  
Z: SET PANEL STATUS  
S: DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Remote Control Unit (Ex. BKS-R3206)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4. Menu Screen  
3 BKS-R1607, BKS-R1608, BKS-R3209, BKS-R3210  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R1607 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 3  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
H: SET PHANTOM TABLE  
N: SET PANEL TABLE  
O: SET AVAILABLE SOURCE/DESTINATION  
R: SET ROUTE  
L: COPY TABLE DATA  
Z: SET PANEL STATUS  
S: DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Remote Control Unit (Ex. BKS-R1607)  
n
BKS-R1608/R3209 does not have the menu item [O].  
4 BKS-R3216, BKS-R1617, BKS-R1618, BKS-R3219, BKS-R3220, BKS-R1621  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3216 V1.03 STATION NUMBER 2  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
H: SET PHANTOM TABLE  
N: SET PANEL TABLE  
O: SET AVAILABLE SOURCE/DESTINATION  
R: SET ROUTE  
L: COPY TABLE DATA  
Z: SET PANEL STATUS  
Y: SET DISPLAY MODES  
S: DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Remote Control Unit (Ex. BKS-R3216)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4. Menu Screen  
3-4-3. Menu screen of the primary station on monitor S-BUS  
To call the menu screen of the primary station on the monitor S-BUS, select menu item [R: CALL  
SECONDARY STATION] in the primary station menu on the standard S-BUS. (The switcher set as the  
primary station on the monitor S-BUS.)  
Next, select menu item [M: SET MONITOR FUNCTION].  
n
If a switcher except the primary station on the monitor S-BUS is selected, this menu will not be displayed  
even if [M: SET MONITOR FUNCTION] has been performed.  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B + BKDS-V3292B (Monitor board)  
SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
DVS-V6464B Monitor Bus I/F V2.10  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
F: SET SCTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
M: SELECT MONITOR FUNCTION ( COMBINED )  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
Menu Screen of the Primary Station on Monitor S-BUS (Ex. DVS-V6464B)  
3-4-4. Menu screen of the secondary station on monitor S-BUS  
To call the menu screen of the secondary station on the monitor S-BUS, call the primary station on the  
monitor S-BUS in advance.  
Select menu item [R: CALL SECONDARY STATION] and input the station number.  
(1) Routing switcher  
1 DVS-V3232B/V6464B + BKDS-V3292B (Monitor board)  
SET MONITOR FUNCTION DVS-V6464B Monitor Bus I/F V2.10 STATION NUMBER 8  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
M: SET AVAILABLE MONITOR LINE INPUT=( ENABLE )OUTPUT=( ENABLE )  
Ctrl-Z:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (Ex. DVS-V6464B)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4. Menu Screen  
(2) Remote control unit  
1 BKS-R3202  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3202 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 14  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
S: DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Ctrl-Z:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (Ex. BKS-R3202)  
2 BKS-R3204, BKS-R3205  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3204 V3.11 STATION NUMBER 18  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
N: SET PANEL TABLE  
L: COPY TABLE DATA  
Z: SET PANEL STATUS  
S: DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Ctrl-Z:RETURN  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (Ex. BKS-R3204)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-5. Setting Screen  
3-5. Setting Screen  
Set the items in the menu in the setting screen.  
To call the setting screen, select the menu item with the cursor key or input it using the alphabet key, and  
press [Enter].  
(The same procedure for calling the setting screen is applied to both the primary station menu and  
secondary station menu.)  
The screen returns to the menu screen when [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed at each menu item.  
Then if [Ctrl] _ [X] is pressed, the screen will return to the system status screen.  
n
The setting screen of menu items “C“, “D”, “E”, “H”, “L”, “M”, “N”, “O”, and “Q” may differ according  
to the source/destination name mode set at menu item “J”.  
For the “Type + Num” mode:  
. The name of the destination or source will be displayed in the form of type name and number.  
. To set or change the name, select any name from the list displayed at the bottom of the screen and  
then input it using the numerical keys.  
For the “DESCRIP.NAME” mode:  
. The name of the destination or source will be displayed in the form of the Description.  
. To set or change the name, directly input it using the alphabet or numerical keys.  
Unless otherwise noted, the setting screen used in this manual are that of the “Type + Num” mode.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4  
Setup Procedure  
4-1. Outline  
This setup procedure is written for the setup operator to understand the setup procedure, and more  
importantly, the philosophy behind the setup. Time spent now, before actually sitting down at the Setup  
Terminal will greatly enhance the flexibility of your router system (routing switcher system). If your  
system is only comprised of DVS-V**** routing switchers the setup approach is much simpler, and  
pretty strait forward. But, if your router system is comprised of more the one type of routing switcher  
(AES/EBU, Analog Audio, or Video, Time Code, RS-422A Remote, etc.) it is very important that you  
understand what you read in this procedure before you actually start the setup procedure.  
A router system with different types of routing switchers should usually be thought of as a 3 dimensional  
object. We will see in this procedure that in a few cases the old 2 dimensional model of a X-Y matrix  
switch will do. But, the most flexibility is obtained by thinking of each type of routing switcher as a  
separate, and distinct Z layer, or level (see figure 2).  
Regarding detailed setup information, refer to the menus explanation in the Installation manuals chapter  
on setup.  
What we will do in this procedure is to:  
1. Identify all in/out signals, and segregate them into 16 types of sources and destinations.  
2. Assign virtual inputs, and outputs a “Type + number” name. (numbers start at 001 and go to 512  
for both source, and destinations)  
3. Assign each output “Type + number” name to one or more levels.  
4. Assign each “Type + number” name to an actual physical in/out location.  
5. Assign any needed phantoms (also known as “salvos”).  
6. Decide which control units can be active on the S-BUS, and displayed in various diagnostic  
modes.  
7. Decide which inputs won’t be available at selected outputs.  
8. Setup any “tie lines” needed.  
9. Assign second naming convention (if desired).  
10. Setup individual control units on the S-BUS data link.  
Regarding steps 1 through 4, these are important steps (with step 2 being the longest, and most critical).  
As an introductory explanation, it should be clear that we humans like to deal in names, while the S-BUS  
control system deals in numbered labels, which the primary (main routing switcher frame) will translate  
into actual physical inputs, and outputs. Many facilities will base the mnemonics used in all documenta-  
tion based on the limitations imposed by routing switcher names, and display windows.  
For details of setting information, refer to the Section 5.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2. Preliminary Information Before Installation  
4-2. Preliminary Information Before Installation  
The control area of each switcher when used as the primary station is as follows.  
Model  
area  
Input control  
area  
Output control  
management  
Level  
Remarks  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-A3232  
DVS-RS1616  
DVS-TC3232  
1 to 512  
1 to 512  
1 to 512  
1 to 512  
1 to 8  
Expansion possible  
DVS-V3232B  
DVS-V1616  
BVS-V3232  
BVS-A3232  
BKPF-R70  
1 to 8  
Expansion not possible  
HDS-V3232  
Example : DVS-V3232B and HDS-V3232 have 32 inputs and 32 outputs. But when one of them set the  
primary station, it can control up to 512 inputs and 512 outputs using the cascading secondary  
stations.  
. Be sure to set a station number for each routing switcher and remote control unit installed.  
Refer to the manuals of each unit for how to set the station number.  
. In this manual, the input signal is called source, and the output signal destination.  
. When using two or more BKS-R1607, BKS-R3209 or BKS-R3210 for a mother and daughter configu-  
ration (combined system), it is necessary to set DVS-V3232B /V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 as  
the primary station.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-3. Preparation Before Setup  
4-3. Preparation Before Setup  
1. Set a primary station  
DVS-V6464B or DVS-V3232B is recommended as the primary station.  
Set M/S switch on the CPU-149 board to “M” position*1.  
Station ID automatically will equal one.  
n
Set only one primary station.  
If more than two are set as the primary, they will not work correctly.  
2. Connect PC  
Connect a IBM compatible PC with MS-DOS Ver. 6.2 to the Remote 3 on the primary, using RS-232C  
cross-cable with 25-pin (male) and 9-pin (female) connectors*2.  
Run terminal emulation software and communicate at 9600 bps*3.  
The Terminal program associated with Windows 3.1 allows the mapping of control strings to virtual  
function keys in the terminal program. Therefore, if your are using Windows 3.1 you can use it’s Termi-  
nal program. Windows 95, and Windows NT have terminal emulation programs which do not have this  
feature. If you are using a PC with Windows 95 or Windows NT, you must use a third party terminal  
emulation program that allows control strings to be mapped to keys on the keyboard (usually the F1  
through F12 function keys).  
3. Turn on the power  
Turn on the power of all equipment connecting on the S-BUS line.  
n
Operation of the routing switcher may be unstable just after the power is turned on. Wait about one  
minute of warm-up before starting the setup.  
*1 : Set the P/S switch of the BKPF-R70 board to “P” position.  
*2 : Use the cross-cable with 9-pin (female) and 9-pin (female) connectors for BKPF-R70.  
*3 : Data transfer speed of BKPF-R70 is 38400 bps.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
1. Identify all in/out signals, and segregate them into 16 types of sources and destinations  
(1) Make IN/OUT list of each routing switcher  
Make input/output list of each routing switcher referring to installation, or wiring diagram or other  
documentation showing router interconnection. Figure 1 shows an example of a 3 router system. It is  
composed of an SDI, AES/EBU, and a Analog routing switcher.  
At this time consider the mnemonics that can be assigned to each of the inputs or outputs.  
The DVS series routing switcher can accept up to 16 unique, 4 letter (maximum) pre-fix names, such as  
CG, VT, VTR, CAM, NET, SAT, BARS, TONE, etc.. The default mnemonics are IN for the input side,  
and OUT for the output side.  
n
Type Name = Mnemonics  
Each pre-fix type can have 1000 items associated with it (VTR000, VTR001, ....VTR999). These 16 pre-  
fixes you generate will be used on both the input, and output sides. What this means is that each input, or  
output to the routing switcher will be referred to in a “Type + number” format (see the examples in the  
upper right hand corner of figure 1.  
The same name (such as VTR001) can be assigned to a input, and to an output of the routing switcher.  
But, a unique name can only be used once per input, and output. It is important that you consider careful-  
ly your naming convention now, as it will be carried throughout the rest of the setup, and will be the name  
displayed on control panels, and other displays. Actual Source and Destination descriptive names are  
decided later.  
n
There is a second naming convention that can be used in place of the “Type + number” format.  
But it is necessary to first enter names under the just mentioned format, and add the second set of names  
later (they do not erase the “Type + number” set). The second approach is called Descriptive Names. It  
is explained in step 9.  
Example :  
VIDEO ROUTER SOURCE  
Generic Source Name  
Connector  
Router Source Name  
CAMERA 1  
CAMERA 2  
VTR 1  
17  
18  
1
CAM001  
CAM002  
VTR001  
VTR002  
VTR 2  
2
VIDEO ROUTER DESTINATION  
Generic Destination Name  
Connector  
Router Destination Name  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
1
2
3
4
VTR001  
VTR002  
VTR003  
VTR004  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
IN  
OUT  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
Name Types  
VTR  
CAM  
SS  
CG  
SAT  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
NET  
REM  
STU  
FS  
NEWS  
PTCH  
DIG  
MON  
DAT  
MIX  
VTR 8  
Studio A  
News 1  
8
9
8
9
VTR 8  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
Camera 1  
Camera 2  
Camera 3  
Camera 4  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
Studio B  
Patch  
News 2  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Cam Ret 1  
Cam Ret 2  
Cam Ret 3  
Cam Ret 4  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Mon  
Studio B Mon  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
News 3  
SDI  
Routing Switcher  
TEST  
Studio B Switch  
Studio B Switch  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
D/A #1  
Patch  
Patch  
Patch  
A/D #1  
DVS-V3232B  
IN  
OUT  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
1
2
1
2
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
3
3
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
4
4
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
5
5
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
6
6
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
7
7
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
DAT 1  
8
9
AES/EBU  
Routing Switcher  
8
9
VTR 8  
DAT 1  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
A/D #1  
A/D #2  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
D/A #1  
D/A #2  
Mixer 1 In 1  
Mixer 1 In 2  
SDI Mux In  
Mixer 1 PGM  
Mixer 1 Aux  
SDI Demux Out  
DVS-A3232  
IN  
OUT  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
1
2
1
2
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
3
3
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
4
4
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
5
5
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
6
6
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Mixer 2 PGM Out  
News 1  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Analog  
Audio  
Routing Switcher  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
News 2  
A/D #1  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
A/D #2  
BVS-A3232  
Fig. 1  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
(2) Assign Name Types (Menu Item [B])  
Now select, and enter your 16 source and destination name pre-fixes.  
Once again, up to 16 type names used for source/destination name are decided using 4 letters (except “;”).  
Set using the menu item [B : SET SOURCE/DESTINATION TYPE].  
Example : CAM, VTR, CG, DVE, MON, PGM, BLK, DAT, STL, TONE, CD, ...  
If a consistent display format is desired, all name types should be the same length.  
SOURCE/DEST/PHANTOM TYPE DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
0=VTR 1=VCR  
2=AUX 3=FLM 4=TEST 5=STU 6=CAM  
7=REM  
8=CG 9=NETA A=ENG B=ED  
C=FS D=SS E=BARS F=PHAN  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
2. Source/Destination names (Menu Items [C] & [D])  
At this point another very important decision must be made as to how your router system is organized,  
programmed, and ultimately able to be used. You should take some time at this point to read, and totally  
understand the implications of what this step in the setup means for future routing switcher setup, opera-  
tion, and flexibility. How you approach this step will greatly determine the flexibility your system will  
afford in control panel operation, and ease of system modification.  
Many router systems are not only comprised of a SDI routing switcher (DVS-V**** routing switcher  
frames), but additional types of routing switchers as well. If you only have DVS-V**** type SDI  
routing switchers the information presented is not as critical to your operation, but should be read for  
background information anyway. These additional routing switchers usually are analog audio, and/or  
video routing switchers. Other possible routing switchers include AES/EBU, Analog Audio, Time Code,  
and RS-422 machine control systems. These other routing switchers are usually controlled by the SDI  
“primary” frame. This will be the case if you are using this guide for router system setup.  
These additional types of routing switchers can be thought of as “assets” (secondary stations) to be  
managed by the primary. These “assets” are additional crosspoints for switching analog video, or audio,  
time code, etc. Your method for controlling these additional crosspoints are generally though control  
panels attached to the S-BUS. Your mix of control panels, and the number, and type of additional, or  
secondary routing switchers will determine the approach taken for “mapping” all the various crosspoints  
in the primary, and secondary routing switchers.  
There are two general approaches that can be taken in “mapping” crosspoints.  
Although either approach can be mutually exclusive of the other, generally a mixture of the two are used.  
The first approach is called “level mapping”. There are sources where the digital (video), and analog  
audio or video routing switchers should naturally follow one another (VTR’s for instance). With sources  
that should follow, you can use “level mapping”, with the SDI routing switcher on level 1, and the audio  
analog routing switcher on level 2, etc..  
Looking at figure 1, VTR001 could have:  
its SDI input connected to DVS-V*** routing switcher output 1,  
and its AES/EBU audio input connected to DVS-A3232 routing switcher output 1,  
and its analog audio input connected to analog audio routing switcher out 1.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
Figure 2 shows that no two levels need to occupy the same size space in the X, and Y directions. As our  
example in figure 1 demonstrates, level 1 could be 32 by 32 in 2 dimensional X, Y space, while levels 2,  
and 3 are only 16 by 16.  
Actually each level could occupy different size X, and Y space. Finally, it should be clear that Z “depth”,  
is three in our case since we have 3 levels.  
Levels Can occupy different size 2 dimensional space  
Level 1  
Level 2  
Z
Y
X
Level 3  
Fig. 2  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
Going back to the VTR 1 example, each of the 3 routing switcher outputs (SDI, AES/EBU, and analog  
audio) could be assigned to a different level, under the VTR001 label.  
Whenever destination VTR001 was selected all 3 crosspoints in the 3 different routing switchers would  
switch together. This approach is often the simpler approach to implement, and understand, but it can  
limit future flexibility in operation, as we will see.  
Level Mapping  
Level 1  
Input (Sources)  
Level 2  
Level 3  
Output  
(Destinations)  
Fig. 3  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
With this approach, you need the control terminal connected to the primary routing switcher, or a control  
panel that allows access to individual “levels”, like the BKS-R1607, BKS-R1608, BKS-R3209 or BKS-  
R3210 to control only one level of VTR001 routing.  
Figure 4 shows this approach.  
Level Approach  
Inputs  
Outputs  
SDI  
AES/EBU  
Routing Switcher  
Analog  
Routing Switcher  
SDI  
AES/EBU  
Routing Switcher  
Analog  
Routing Switcher  
Routing Switcher  
Routing Switcher  
Level 1  
Level 2  
Level 3  
Level 1  
Level 2  
Level 3  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 3  
VTR 3  
VTR 3  
VTR 3  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 4  
VTR 4  
VTR 4  
VTR 4  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 5  
VTR 5  
VTR 5  
VTR 5  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 6  
VTR 6  
VTR 6  
VTR 6  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 7  
VTR 7  
VTR 7  
VTR 7  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
VTR 8  
VTR 8  
VTR 8  
VTR 8  
VTR 8  
Studio A  
News 1  
DAT 1  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
A/D #1  
Mixer 2 PGM Out  
News 1  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
DAT 1  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
D/A #1  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
News 2  
A/D #1  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
Camera 1  
Camera 2  
Camera 3  
Camera 4  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
Studio B  
Patch  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
A/D #2  
D/A #2  
Mixer 1 PGM  
Mixer 1 Aux  
SDI Demux Out  
News 2  
Mixer 1 In 1  
Mixer 1 In 2  
SDI Mux In  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Cam Ret 1  
Cam Ret 2  
Cam Ret 3  
Cam Ret 4  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Mon  
Studio A Mon  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
News 3  
A/D #2  
Studio B Switch  
Studio B Switch  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
D/A #1  
Patch  
Patch  
Patch  
A/D #1  
Fig. 4  
The second approach is “virtual mapping”. There are sources that don’t logically follow one another,  
looking at figure 4, you can see that News 1, and DAT 2 on the source side, Satellite 1, and DAT 1 on the  
destination side are just 2 of many that wouldn’t normally be switched together. In this case the approach  
shown in figure 5 could be used.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
Virtual Approach  
Inputs  
Outputs  
Source Connector  
Destination Connector  
Name  
Physical Inputs  
Physical Outputs  
Name  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Studio A  
News 1  
Satelite 1  
Satelite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
Camera 1  
Camera 2  
Camera 3  
Camera 4  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
Studio B  
Patch  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
VTR 101  
VTR 102  
VTR 103  
VTR 104  
VTR 105  
VTR 106  
VTR 107  
VTR 108  
STU 111  
NEWS 101  
SAT 101  
SAT 102  
NET 101  
NET 102  
REM 101  
REM 102  
CAM 001  
CAM 002  
CAM 003  
CAM 004  
SS 001  
VTR 101  
VTR 102  
VTR 103  
VTR 104  
VTR 105  
VTR 106  
VTR 107  
VTR 108  
SAT 101  
SAT 102  
REM 001  
NET 101  
NEWS 101  
NEWS 102  
CG 001  
News 2  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Cam Ret 1  
Cam Ret 2  
Cam Ret 3  
Cam Ret 4  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Mon  
Studio B Mon  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
News 3  
SDI  
Routing  
Switcher  
SDI  
Routing  
Switcher  
CG 002  
CAM 001  
CAM 002  
CAM 003  
CAM 004  
STU 111  
STU 112  
MUN 111  
MUN 121  
SS 001  
SS 002  
CG 001  
CG 002  
FS 001  
FS 002  
SS 002  
Studio B Switch  
Studio B Switch  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
D/A #1  
STU 121  
PTCH 001  
PTCH 002  
PTCH 003  
PTCH 004  
DIG 101  
VTR 201  
VTR 202  
VTR 203  
VTR 204  
VTR 205  
VTR 206  
VTR 207  
VTR 208  
DAT 001  
DAT 002  
DAT 003  
DIG 201  
DIG 202  
MIX 201  
MIX 202  
DIG 203  
VTR 301  
VTR 302  
VTR 303  
VTR 304  
VTR 305  
VTR 306  
VTR 307  
VTR 308  
MIX 201  
NEWS 301  
SAT 301  
SAT 302  
NET 301  
NET 302  
REM 301  
REM 302  
NEWS 103  
STU 121  
STU 122  
FS 001  
Patch  
Patch  
Patch  
A/D #1  
FS 002  
DIG 101  
VTR 201  
VTR 202  
VTR 203  
VTR 204  
VTR 205  
VTR 206  
VTR 207  
VTR 208  
DAT 001  
DAT 002  
DAT 003  
DIG 201  
DIG 202  
MIX 201  
MIX 202  
DSP 203  
VTR 301  
VTR 302  
VTR 303  
VTR 304  
VTR 305  
VTR 306  
VTR 307  
VTR 308  
SAT 301  
SAT 302  
REM 301  
NET 301  
NEWS 301  
NEWS 302  
DIG 301  
DIG 302  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
DAT 1  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
A/D #1  
A/D #2  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
DAT 1  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
D/A #1  
D/A #2  
Mixer 1 In 1  
Mixer 1 In 2  
SDI Mux In  
AES/EBU  
Routing  
Switcher  
AES/EBU  
Routing  
Switcher  
Mixer 1 PGM  
Mixer 1 Aux  
SDI Demux Out  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
News 2  
A/D #1  
Analog  
Routing  
Switcher  
Analog  
Routing  
Switcher  
Mixer 2 PGM Out  
News 1  
Satelite 1  
Satelite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
A/D #2  
Fig. 5  
A pure virtual mapping approach would keep all destinations on 1 virtual level (although physically there  
is still 3 levels) as figure 5 shows.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
Example : Destinations  
. Satellite 1 connected to SDI routing switcher OUT 9  
(SDI routing switcher given label destinations 001-032)  
. DAT 1 connected to AES/EBU routing switcher OUT 9  
(AES/EBU routing switcher given label destinations 033-048)  
. Satellite 1 connected to Analog Audio OUT 9  
(Analog audio routing switcher given label destinations 049-064)  
Therefore :  
SDI Satellite 1  
AES/EBU  
Analog Audio Satellite 1  
(Sat001) ········· virtual level 1 out label 9  
(DAT001) ······ virtual level 1 out label 41  
(Sat003) ········· virtual level 1 out label 57  
If DAT001 destination is changed on a control panel only output label 41 (AES OUT 9) changes. Good  
in situations where few signals logically follow from one level to the next (DAT’s and cameras, Mics and  
CG’s, Audio Mixers and Still Stores, etc.). With this approach any sources/ destinations that should  
follow across multiple routing switchers would require phantoms (covered later) to implement multiple  
crosspoints switched.  
A combination of virtual, and level mapping combines both approaches as shown in figure 6.  
Level 1  
Virtural and Level Mapping  
Level 2  
Level 3  
Fig. 6  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
With this approach sources, and destinations like the VTR’s would be level mapped together so that all 3  
routing switchers switch at the same time under the VTR001, VTR002, etc. label.  
But in the case of output 11, of each of the 3 routing switchers, the 1, and 3 levels (SDI, and analog audio  
respectively) would be level mapped and switched together (REM001) while output 11 of level 2, which  
is DAT003 would be virtually mapped off away from the other 2, so that it could be easily switched on  
it’s own.  
Example : Level 1, & level 3 outputs 11 are tied together under the REM001 label  
Level 2, mapped out from under level 1 output 11 under the DAT003 label  
If DAT003 destination is changed on a control panel only level 2 output 11 crosspoint on the AES/EBU  
routing switcher changes. If REM001 destination is changed both levels 1, and 3 change. This approach  
is good for a mixture of signals where routing levels follow in some instances, but not always.  
n
Sources/Destinations where all associated crosspoints on all levels should follow would be mapped only  
by levels. Sources/Destinations which shouldn’t follow would be mapped virtually.  
Again, a pure level mapping approach is where all physical inputs 1, 2, etc are tied together on different  
levels (see figure 4).  
A pure level mapping approach is usually the worst approach. In our example here DAT 3, which is on  
output 11 of the AES/EBU routing switcher appears as REM001 on all control, and display, panels if the  
level only approach is taken.  
Using the virtual/level mixture approach you will get separate video, and audio tallies (control panel push  
button lit). As an example, (see figures 7, and 8) if you use the 2 entries from the virtual example above  
and assign both of them to the same control panel (on different buttons), if REM001 is selected with it’s  
button, the REM 1 button is tallied green. Now if DAT001 is selected with it’s button, the DAT 3 button  
is tallied amber, while the REM001 button remains green. The DAT001 button will stay tallied when  
other sources are selected as long as those sources are assigned to level 1, or 3, and not level 2.  
When a button is selected with levels 1, and 2 active the DAT001 audio source button is turned off, as the  
primary switches both levels of crosspoints.  
Conversely, if REM 1 (green tally) is selected, and DAT 3 (amber tally) is selected, and another level 2  
only source is selected, say DAT 2, the DAT 3 amber tally will extinguish, and the DAT 2 button will  
now be tallied amber. The REM 1 green tally will remain on, unchanged.  
A final note on figure 7.  
This is a two dimensional drawing depicting a 3 dimensional object. Therefore the top half of the draw-  
ing represents the X axis, the bottom half the Y axis, and from left to right the Z axis.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Studio A  
News 1  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
Camera 1  
Camera 2  
Camera 3  
Camera 4  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
Studio B  
Patch  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
VTR 001  
VTR 002  
VTR 003  
VTR 004  
VTR 005  
VTR 006  
VTR 007  
VTR 008  
STU 111  
NEWS 001  
SAT 001  
SAT 002  
NET 101  
NET 102  
REM 101  
REM 102  
CAM 001  
CAM 002  
CAM 003  
CAM 004  
SS 001  
Mixer 2 PGM 0  
News 1  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Network 1  
Network 2  
Remote 1  
Remote 2  
Mixed Level/  
Virtual Approach  
Level 3  
(Analog Audio)  
SS 002  
CG 001  
CG 002  
FS 001  
FS 002  
STU 121  
PTCH 001  
PTCH 002  
PTCH 003  
PTCH 004  
DIG 101  
DAT 001  
DAT 002  
DAT 003  
DIG 201  
DIG 202  
MIX 201  
MIX 202  
DIG 203  
Level 2  
(AES/EBU)  
Input/Sources  
Patch  
Patch  
Patch  
A/D #1  
DAT 1  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
A/D #1  
A/D #2  
Level 1 (SDI)  
Mixer 1 PGM  
Mixer 1 Aux  
SDI Demux Out  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Satellite 1  
Satellite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
VTR 1  
VTR 2  
VTR 3  
VTR 4  
VTR 5  
VTR 6  
VTR 7  
VTR 8  
Satelite 1  
Satelite 2  
Remote 1  
Network 1  
News 1  
News 2  
VTR 001  
VTR 002  
VTR 003  
VTR 004  
VTR 005  
VTR 006  
VTR 007  
VTR 008  
SAT 001  
SAT 002  
REM 001  
NET 001  
NEWS 001  
NEWS 002  
CG 001  
News 2  
Char Gen 1  
Char Gen 2  
Cam Ret 1  
Cam Ret 2  
Cam Ret 3  
Cam Ret 4  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Switch  
Studio A Mon  
Studio B Mon  
Still Store 1  
Still Store 2  
News 3  
CG 002  
CAM 001  
CAM 002  
CAM 003  
CAM 004  
STU 111  
STU 112  
MON 111  
MON 112  
SS 001  
Level 3  
(Analog Audio)  
Level 2  
(AES/EBU)  
SS 002  
Output/  
Destinations  
NEWS103  
STU 121  
STU 122  
FS 001  
Studio B Switch  
Studio B Switch  
Frame Sync 1  
Frame Sync 2  
D/A #1  
FS 002  
DIG 101  
DAT 001  
DAT 002  
DAT 003  
DIG 201  
DIG 202  
MIX 201  
MIX 202  
DIG 203  
DIG 301  
DIG 302  
DAT 1  
DAT 2  
DAT 3  
D/A #1  
D/A #2  
Mixer 1 In 1  
Mixer 1 In 2  
SDI Mux In  
Level 1 (SDI)  
A/D #1  
A/D #2  
Fig. 7  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
Now select suitable names for sources/destinations using Type name, and number and enter them in the  
IN/OUT list of each routing switcher (menu item [C]).  
Remember that you have to attention to the ins, and outs of routing switchers on all levels when you build  
this list.  
Example :  
VIDEO ROUTER SOURCE  
Connected to  
Connector  
Source Name  
CAMERA-1  
CAMERA-2  
VTR-1  
17  
18  
1
017=CAM001  
018=CAM002  
001=VTR001  
002=VTR002  
VTR-2  
2
VIDEO ROUTER DESTINATION  
Connected to  
Connector  
Destination Name  
VTR-1  
VTR-2  
VTR-3  
VTR-4  
1
2
3
4
001=VTR001  
002=VTR002  
003=VTR003  
004=VTR004  
n
After destination (crosspoint/output) names have been set, the Protect mode may be implemented for that  
destination (crosspoint can’t select another input).  
After source (inputs) names have been set, the Secret mode may be implemented for the source (input not  
selectable by control panels).  
Both of these modes can be only be set, or disabled via the terminal.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
3. Set Level Table (Menu Item [E])  
This is the step where you assign what levels you want each name or label to be assigned to. You also  
assign the names of the various levels (here SDI, AES, and AUD are used).  
The information entered here was derived from figure 7.  
1=SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
SDI  
:
2=AES  
AES  
AES  
AES  
AES  
AES  
AES  
AES  
AES  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
:
3=AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
AUD  
:
4=  
....  
001 VTR001  
002 VTR002  
003 VTR003  
004 VTR004  
005 VTR005  
006 VTR006  
007 VTR007  
008 VTR008  
009 SAT001  
010 SAT002  
011 REM001  
012 NET001  
013 NEWS001  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
035 DIG203  
036 MIX201  
037 MIX202  
038 DIG203  
039 DIG301  
040 DIG302  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
AES  
AES  
AES  
AES  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
AUD  
AUD  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
n
Delete levels not used so that these levels do not show on panels, or displays that use levels. The deleted  
levels are displays as “ . . . .”.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
4. Physical Assignment (Menu Item [L])  
Now we actually associate the labels or names to a physical routing switcher input or output. Assign the  
physical source/destination number and the physical level to the virtual source/destination name and the  
virtual levels using the menu item [L : SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT].  
Again refer to figure 7.  
PHYSICAL NUMBER ASSIGNMENT  
DVS-V3232B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE  
LEVEL  
VID  
No. NAME  
AES  
AUD  
4
5
6
7
001 VTR001  
002 VTR002  
003 VTR003  
004 VTR004  
005 VTR005  
006 VTR006  
007 VTR007  
008 VTR008  
009 STU111  
001-1  
002-1  
003-1  
004-1  
005-1  
006-1  
007-1  
008-1  
009-1  
001-2  
002-2  
003-2  
004-2  
005-2  
006-2  
007-2  
008-2  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
:
001-3  
002-3  
003-3  
004-3  
005-3  
006-3  
007-3  
008-3  
009-3  
010-3  
011-3  
:
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
:
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
:
010 NEWS001 010-1  
011 SAT001  
011-1  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
017 CAM001  
018 CAM002  
017-1  
018-1  
:
...-.  
...-.  
:
...-.  
...-.  
:
...-.  
...-.  
:
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
033 DAT001  
034 DAT002  
035 DAT003  
036 DIG201  
037 DIG202  
038 MIX201  
039 MIX202  
040 DIG203  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
009-2  
010-2  
011-2  
012-2  
013-2  
014-2  
015-2  
016-2  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
m
1. Create a similar table for the destination side (use F5 on the terminal setup menu [L] screen to toggle  
between source/destination)  
2. To delete an entry in menu item [L], press the [Ctrl] _ [P] .  
This step can be confusing because you associate the input labels with physical routing switcher inputs,  
along with output labels with physical outputs. You need to tell the primary which physical X row of  
crosspoints feeding an output belong with each output name or label, along with which physical Y  
column of crosspoints fed by an input belong with each input name or label. To visualize, look at figures  
2, 3, or 4.  
n
When BKPF-R70 is used as the primary station, all contents that have been set are cleared when  
“A : /CLR-DATA/SBUS_LVG_DAT” which is supplied with BZR-10.  
When number of items to set is smaller than number of items to clear, the procedure of clearing all items  
once and setting all items from the very beginning is more efficient.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
Additionally, an individual routing switcher can be divided in 2, or more virtual routing switchers. This  
means that one level can be made to look like 2, or more levels. In our example our 3 level routing  
switcher could have the AES/EBU routing switcher split into 2 virtual levels.  
Our 3 routing switcher system would now have 4 levels.  
Why would you want to do this? If you have an AES/EBU routing switcher that handles 2 AES/EBU  
audio programs per digital signal, but your plant uses 4 channels, this means it takes 2 AES/EBU signals  
for 4 channels. As before, there would be many times that you would want to switch these together, and  
many times you would not. Also, in many cases you would have only one AES/EBU audio frame.  
Therefore, AES/EBU Channels 1/2 would arrive at one input while AES/EBU Channels 3/4 would arrive  
at another input of the same routing switcher. You could use phantoms (step 8) to link these inputs  
together when desired, or you could create 2 distinct levels for one physical routing switcher frame using  
menu item [L]. One level could be known as A1/2, and the second A3/4. Entries to do this might look  
like the examples below.  
PHYSICAL NUMBER ASSIGNMENT  
DVS-V3232B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE  
LEVEL  
VID  
No. NAME  
A12  
A34  
4
5
6
7
001 VTR001  
002 VTR002  
003 VTR003  
004 VTR004  
005 VTR005  
006 VTR006  
007 VTR007  
008 VTR008  
001-1  
002-1  
003-1  
004-1  
005-1  
006-1  
007-1  
008-1  
001-2  
002-2  
003-2  
004-2  
005-2  
006-2  
007-2  
008-2  
016-2  
017-2  
018-2  
019-2  
020-2  
021-2  
022-2  
023-2  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
PHYSICAL NUMBER ASSIGNMENT  
DVS-V3232B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE  
LEVEL  
VID  
No. NAME  
A12  
A34  
4
5
6
7
001 VTR001  
002 VTR002  
003 VTR003  
004 VTR004  
005 VTR005  
006 VTR006  
007 VTR007  
008 VTR008  
001-1  
002-1  
003-1  
004-1  
005-1  
006-1  
007-1  
008-1  
001-2  
003-2  
005-2  
007-2  
009-2  
011-2  
013-2  
015-2  
002-2  
004-2  
006-2  
008-2  
010-2  
012-2  
014-2  
016-2  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
This is a good place to point out that physical crosspoint usage does not have to  
be in numerical order.  
PHYSICAL NUMBER ASSIGNMENT  
DVS-V3232B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE  
LEVEL  
VID  
No. NAME  
A12  
A34  
4
5
6
7
001 VTR001  
002 VTR002  
003 VTR003  
004 VTR004  
005 VTR005  
006 VTR006  
007 VTR007  
008 VTR008  
005-1  
006-1  
007-1  
008-1  
001-1  
002-1  
003-1  
004-1  
032-2  
030-2  
028-2  
026-2  
008-2  
006-2  
004-2  
002-2  
031-2  
029-2  
027-2  
025-2  
007-2  
005-2  
003-2  
001-2  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-. ...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
...-.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
5. Phantoms (Menu Item [H])  
Now we will create any necessary phantoms. First we must define the phantom globally, and then allow  
it’s usage by individual control panels. A phantom allows you to have a number of outputs select new  
inputs all at once.  
An instance of a global in our example would be the selection of input SAT001 (SDI level and the Analog  
audio level) to output VTR001, and DIG201 (AES level) to output VTR001. We could call this phantom  
SAT999. It’s entry as a global phantom would look like this  
(1) In the top of menu item [H] we would assign our name to a numbered label:  
0001 SAT999  
0005 ......  
0002 ......  
0006 ......  
0003 ......  
0007 ......  
0004 ......  
0007 ......  
(2) Once the name is assigned we are in an edit menu, where we actually assign inputs to outputs:  
1=SDI  
2=AES  
3=AUD  
VTR001 < SAT001  
VTR001 < DIG201  
1
....  
....  
2
3
....  
Up to 4096 crosspoint changes can be stored among the Global phantoms.  
For a control panel to be able to use a global phantom, that secondary station must be called (menu item  
[R]), and the name of the global phantom loaded into it’s phantom table. Up to 57 crosspoint *1 changes  
can be stored among each secondary stations (control panels) phantoms.  
Local phantoms may be created in each control panel. Below is an example of a local phantom residing  
in a control panels phantom table :  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PHANTOM TABLE(PHANTOM:DESTINATION<SOURCE-LEVEL)(G.PAHNTOM NAME:NUMBER)  
SAT999:0001 CAM999:CAM001<STU111 -1 CAM999:CAM002<STU111 -1  
BKS-R3206 V3.11  
STATION NUMBER 4  
CAM999:CAM003<STU111 -1 CAM999:CAM004<STU111 -1 ......:......<...... -.  
......:......<...... -. ......:......<...... -. ......:......<...... -.  
......:......<...... -. ......:......<...... -. ......:......<...... -.  
We can see here that our global phantom SAT999 is the first entree. The 0001 that trails SAT999 means  
that this global phantom is the first entry in our global phantom table (menu item [H]). Next we can see  
that locally (only at this control panel) we have defined a local phantom called CAM999. It selects the  
Studio A (STU111) input, and sends it to our 4 camera return outputs (CAM001, etc.) whenever it is  
selected. The _1” means that level 1 (SDI) is switched.  
SAT999, and CAM999 could be assigned to buttons on this control panel just like any other source, or  
destination name could be.  
*1 : Up to 64 crosspoint changes can be stored in BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210 of Ver. 1.10.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
6. Decide Remote Control Units Can Be Active on the S-BUS  
(1) Available Stations (Menu Item [F])  
Make secondary stations available by setting “E” on the menu item [F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER.  
The stations that are enabled will be polled by the primary, for panel activity, and status updates.  
ENABLE ACTIVE UNIT FOR STATION NUMBER  
DVS-V3232B V2.10  
STATION NUMBER 1  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20  
M E E E E E E E  
001-020  
021-040  
n
Before this setting each secondary station has to have its ID set using the dip-switch on the back of the  
control panel. The primary station has ID=1, secondary stations should have ID=2 or later.  
For your reference, ID-00 is the test number, and ID-255 is the global number. Be noted that both of  
them cannot be used.  
(2) Detection of Stations (Menu Item [Z])  
If you set “?” to a ID location in the menu item [Z], the primary station will display the corresponding  
model code of that location and display a warning if communication is interrupted.  
SET UNIT DETECTABLE  
DVS-V3232B V2.10  
STATION NUMBER 1  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20  
M 03?1504 ? ? ?  
001-020  
021-040  
01:DVS-V1616  
06:BKS-R3203  
02:DVS-V3232  
07:BKS-R3281  
03:DVS-A3232  
08:DVS-V6464  
13:BKS-R3204  
04:BKS-R1601  
09:BKS-R5000  
14:BKS-R3205  
05:BKS-R3202  
10:DVS-RS1616  
15:BKS-R3206  
11:DVS-TC3232 12:BKDM-5080  
16:BKS-R3280 17:BZR-1000  
18:DVS-V3232B 19:DVS-V6464B 20:BKDS-7700  
m
1. This menu is used with BZR-10 to select the secondary stations for saving the data. BZR-10 uploads  
the data of the secondary stations only selected with the “?” mark.  
2. BZR-1000 software can not be used when “?” mark is set on in this menu on secondary stations using  
this menu. Continuous “System Event Has Occurred” error messages will be displayed in the BZR-  
1000 GUI if “?” is set for any secondary stations.  
3. Once a “?” is entered you must exit, and re-enter this menu to see the communications result.  
The model code is displayed in “?”.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
7. Inhibit Crosspoint Table (Menu Item [M])  
Set invalid crosspoint table for the specified crosspoints that will not be allowed to be selected by various  
outputs INHIBIT TABLE on the primary station.  
On the table “X” means valid crosspoint, and “_” means invalid crosspoint.  
SET INHIBIT TABLE  
DEST. SOURCE  
DVS-V3232B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
001  
01--08 09--16 17--24 25--32 33--40 41--48 49--56  
VTR001 -X-XXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX  
VTR002 XXX-XXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX  
VTR003 XXXX-XXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX  
VTR004 XXXXX-XX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX  
Be careful that destination cannot select a source which makes up a loop in which the destination be-  
comes the signal generating source in order to avoid potential operational mistake.  
In the example here the output VTR001 can not select input 1 (VTR001), etc.  
8. Tie Line Management (Menu Items [N] & [O])  
This comes into play mainly if you have different types of serial digital data. Such as having both 4fsc,  
and 4:2:2 signal streams in the same routing switcher level. By using the menu item [R : CALL SEC-  
ONDARY STATION] you can have the primary call itself, and configure the primary to handle either  
standard in groups of 8 inputs, and outputs. The same can be done be calling secondary stations on the  
same level.  
If you have both types of signal you probably need to convert from one standard to the other often. To  
prevent the need to have many converters, you can set up the system recursively re-route serial data of  
one type back into the routing switcher with a limited number of converters between routing switcher out  
and routing switcher in. (See figure 8.)  
4:2:2 Inputs  
4fsc Inputs  
4:2:2 Outputs  
4:2:2 to 4fsc  
Converter  
4:2:2 Outputs  
SDI Router  
with both  
4:2:2 & 4fsc  
4fsc to 4:2:2  
Converter  
4fsc Outputs  
4fsc Outputs  
Fig. 8  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
Instead of one large routing switcher, there are often 2 separate routing switchers. One handling 4:2:2,  
and the other 4fsc. The output of the 4:2:2 would cascade through the 4:2:2 to 4fsc converters, and on to  
the inputs of the 4fsc routing switcher. The opposite configuration would be set up for going from 4fsc to  
4:2:2.  
What is done here is that groups of inputs are combined in a Source Name group, along with groups of  
outputs known as Destination Name groups. Net (Path) Groups are then created, each one being a list of  
routing switcher outs to routing switcher in’s to be used.  
When a input in a source group is selected, or an output in a destination group, the routing switcher looks  
at successive paths (their order as entered in each path group) until it finds an unused one.  
n
Each Source, Destination, and Net group can have up to 4 entries in it.  
There can be a total of 20 Source, and 20 Destination groups.  
There can be up to 40 Net groups.  
Each Source and Destination group are tied together by 1 Net group.  
Up to 3 routing switchers, or 2 recursive paths into 1 routing switcher can be supported.  
Source Group  
S001:IN003  
:IN004  
Net Group  
Destination Group  
D001:OUT033  
:OUT034  
N001:OUT003-IN041  
:OUT004-IN042  
:OUT005-IN043  
:OUT006-IN044  
:IN005  
:OUT035  
:IN006  
:OUT036  
S002:IN010  
:IN015  
N002:OUT023-IN051  
:OUT024-IN052  
:OUT025-IN053  
:OUT026-IN054  
D002:OUT056  
:OUT057  
:IN023  
:OUT058  
:IN027  
:OUT059  
PATHS  
1:S001-N001-D001  
2:S002-N002-D001  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
9. Description Name (Menu Item [J])  
In addition to Type + Number names, letter names (16 letters can be displayed on the BKS-R3281, most  
through only display 7) can be used.  
This is called a “Description name”.  
To set to Description names mode, select DESCRIP.NAME using the menu item [J : NAME STYLE].  
Everytime [J] is selected in the System Setup Menu the name mode toggles between Type + Number, and  
Description name modes.  
After [J] has been selected for the first time, go back to menu items [C] and [D] and enter the descriptive  
names, if desired.  
SOURCE NUMBER TRANSCODE  
DVS-V3232B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
001=VTR001 ProgVTR  
003=VTR003 BkupVTR  
002=VTR002 SpotVTR  
004=VTR004 Net-Dly  
:
:
:
:
017=CAM001 Pete  
019=CAM003 Tom  
018=CAM002 Mary  
019=CAM004 John  
n
The description name can be used repeatedly for the sources and destinations.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4. Basic Setup Procedures  
10. Control Panel Setup (Menu Item [R])  
Each individual control panel is contacted, and programmed by selecting [R] in the setup menu, and then  
by entering the S-BUS address of the desired panel. If the control panels are enabled in the menu item [Z  
: SET UNIT DETECTABLE], this might help you identify the panels address in question. If the address  
for the desired panel needs further search select the menu item [X : DISPLAY S-BUS COMMUNICA-  
TIONS], and command a crosspoint change from the panel in question, and observe the address indicated  
by the S-BUS activity.  
Once the menu page of the control panel is displayed select the menu item [Z : SET PANEL STATUS].  
From this sub-menu you can configure which buttons on the panel are inputs or output selects. Also  
whether this panel operates alone or in conjunction with other panels are determined in this menu.  
Next select the menu item [N : SET PANEL TABLE]. Using this sub-menu you assign input/output  
labels, or phantoms to the appropriate switches. (This setting is not necessary in the case of X-Y control.)  
If the panel being programmed is a BKS-R3202, or a BKS-R3206 select the menu item [O : SET AVAIL-  
ABLE DESTINATION]. On BKS-R3202 and BKS-R3206 all sources and destinations can be selected.  
To limit potential operational mistakes destinations which may be controlled can be filtered.  
In BKS-R3210 and BKS-R1607, a setting which limits arbitrary selection of sources is possible using  
[Ctrl] _ [F].  
When there are several control panels with similar, or identical setups you can use the menu item [L :  
COPY TABLE DATA] to copy setup data from one control panel to another.  
n
Use menu item [L : COPY TABLE DATA] from the panel you will copy data to!  
Once you have copied the setup to a new panel you can edit that panels settings through the sub-menus as  
before.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-5. Flowchart of Setup  
4-5. Flowchart of Setup  
Modification  
Initial Setting  
Primary Station Setting  
DVS-V3232/FV6464B : Set S3 to "D" (Default) position on the CPU-149 board, then return  
S3 to "0" position.  
HDS-V3232  
: Set S2 to "D" (Default) position on the CPU-251 board, then return  
S2 to "0" position.  
K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
U: SELECT CONTROL MODE  
P: CHANGE PASSWORD  
T: SET CLOCK  
V: SELECT WARNING DISPLAY  
B: SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE  
J: NAME STYLE  
C: SET DESTINATION NAME  
D: SET SOURCE NAME  
E: SET LEVEL TABLE  
F: SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
L: SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT  
H: SET GLOBAL PHANTOM  
M: SET INHIBIT TABLE  
When Description Name  
N: SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP  
When ' Type + Num ' Name  
O: SET TIE LINES  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
Secondary Station Setting (Switcher)  
K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
Secondary Station Setting (Remote Control Unit)  
L: COPY TABLE DATA  
U:SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL  
A: SET UNIT LOCATION  
Z: SET PANEL STATUS  
N: SET PANEL TABLE  
G: UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
M: SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
O: SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION  
H: SET PHANTOM TABLE  
End  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-6. Setting Up BKPF-300/301/350/351  
4-6. Setting Up BKPF-300/301/350/351  
1. Set the switch S1-3 on BKPF-300/301/350/351 to “OFF (TERMINAL)” position.  
2. Select the menu item [R: CALL SECONDARY STATION] from the menu screen of primary station,  
and call BKPF-300/301/350/351.  
The following screen appears.  
Model name  
Software version indication  
Station address value  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU BKPF-300 VX.XX STATION NUMBER XXX  
SOURCE No: 0001 - 0008  
SWITCHING FIELD: ASYNC  
DESTINASTION No: 0001  
SDI FORMAT: 4:2:2  
LEVEL No: 1  
3
2
1
4
5
Ctrl-D : RETURN  
Ctrl-E : RETURN TO MENU  
(Example of BKPF-300)  
1 SOURCE LOCATION of equipment. Input range is set here.  
2 DESTINATION LOCATION of equipment. Output range is set here.  
3 LEVEL of equipment is set here.  
4 The MATRIX switching timing is set here. (Select either ASYNC or FIELD.)  
5 The SDI format is set here. (Available in BKPF-300 only.)  
(Select a type from three formats of 4: 2: 2, 4fsc NTSC or 4fsc PAL.)  
3. Set the above described items from 1 to 5.  
(1) Set the items from 1 to 3 as follows. Select an area to modify using the cursor key. Enter any  
desired value using the numeric keys on the control terminal.  
(2) Set the items 4 and 5 as follows. Select an area to modify using the cursor key, and press  
[Enter].  
Every pressing of [Enter] increments the preset values in order.  
4. Press [Ctrl] _ [D] to return to the menu screen of primary station from the setting screen.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
4-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5  
System Settings  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
A: DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
A: DISPLAY UNIT LOCATION  
Purpose  
The menu items [A : DISPLAY CONTROL AREA] and  
[A : DISPLAY UNIT LOCATION] are used to check the  
source and destination area of the whole routing system to  
be controlled by the primary station.  
Checking Procedure  
1. Select menu item [A].  
2. Control area is displayed as shown below.  
Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen.  
DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
SOURCE No 0001-0512  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
DESTINATION No 0001-0512  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
The following table lists the control area and setting area  
for each model.  
Model  
Control Area  
Mapping Area  
Input control Output control Setting area  
area  
area  
DVS-RS1616 1 to 512  
1 to 512  
1 to 512  
1 to 128  
1 to 256  
DVS-TC3232 1 to 512  
BVS-V3232  
BVS-A3232  
DVS-V1616 1 to 512  
DVS-V3232B  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-A3232  
1 to 512  
1 to 512  
BKPF-R70  
HDS-V3232  
n
The control area of the menu item [A] means the control  
area of the whole routing system, and not the input/output  
area of the primary station.  
To set the source/destination location of the primary  
station, call the secondary station menu screen by selecting  
menu item [R] and type the station number [1], and then  
select the menu item [A] of the secondary station.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
B: SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE  
C: SET DESTINATION NAME  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is used to set the type name of the source  
destination and global phantom table.  
The menu makes the management of source/destination  
easier.  
This menu is used to set the destination name and protect  
function of each output.  
A number between 001 to 999 and a type name set at the  
menu item [B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE] can be set to  
each destination. Description name can be set by chang-  
ing the name mode at the menu item [J : NAME STYLE].  
For details of setting the name, refer to [J] in the menu.  
The protect function (to protect the output signal from  
being controlled from the remote control unit) prevents the  
source signal selected for the specified destination from  
being switched by other remote control units.  
(During recording and ON AIR, interrupting operations  
can be prevented.)  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [B].  
2. Use the cursor or alphabet/numerical keys and select  
the codes for the type name to be registered from the  
sixteen character codes (0 to 9 and A to F) displayed  
on the screen.  
3. When [Ctrl] _ [P] is pressed, the setting of the type  
name will be canceled, and “ · · · · ” will be displayed.  
4. When [Enter] is pressed, the type name can be set. If  
[Enter] is pressed again before entering the type  
name, the registration will be deleted and the cursor  
moves to the next position.  
5. Use the alphabet and numerical keys to enter the type  
name (within four letters).  
6. When [Enter] is pressed, the type name will be set  
and the cursor moves to the next position.  
If [Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed before the setting, the  
original type name will be returned.  
Setting Procedure (Destination Name)  
1. Select menu item [C].  
2. Press the cursor keys or the function keys to select the  
destination number.  
3. When [Ctrl] _ [P] is pressed, the set destination name  
will be deleted and “ · · · · ” will be displayed.  
4. When [Enter] is pressed, the destination name can be  
typed.  
If [Enter] is pressed again before entering a name, the  
registration will be deleted and the cursor moves to the  
next position.  
7. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen will be  
displayed.  
5. Select the code assigned to each type name, and use  
the numerical keys to enter the destination name.  
6. When [Enter] is pressed, the destination name will be  
set and the cursor moves to the next position.  
If [Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed before the setting, the  
original destination name will be returned.  
7. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen will be  
displayed.  
SOURCE/DEST/PHANTOM TYPE DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
0=VTR 1=VCR  
2=AUX 3=FLM 4=TEST 5=STU 6=CAM  
7=REM  
8=CG 9=NETA A=ENG B=ED  
C=FS D=SS E=BARS F=PHAN  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
n
Operating Function Keys  
1. The same destination name cannot be registered at  
more than two destinations. If this is done, an error  
message will be displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
Example: “VTR001 is used already; Ignored”  
destination name  
[F1] : SEARCH (To move the cursor to the desired  
destination name)  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input DEST.  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination name to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired destination name.  
2. When the Description name mode is selected at menu  
item [J], both Description name and “Type + number”  
name will be displayed.  
n
In this menu, Description name is used for setting.  
When menu item [J] is set to the Description name  
mode, [F1] (SEARCH) will have the following  
functions.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input NAME  
=”will be displayed.  
2. Enter the Description name (within seven  
characters) from the head.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the Description name  
entered will be searched.  
Setting Procedure (Protect Function)  
1. Select the destination name using the cursor, and then  
press [P]. “P” is displayed after the selected destina-  
tion name and the protect function is set.  
Protect function cannot be set for a number whose  
destination name has not been assigned.  
2. To release the protect function, select the destination  
name and press [P] once again.  
4. If the desired name does not exist in the screen,  
press [F1] again.  
m
1. If a destination name is reversed, it means the protect  
function is set with a control terminal and not with a  
remote control unit.  
2. To change the protected destination name, release the  
protection first before beginning the modification  
process.  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the destination  
number)  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NUMBER =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination number to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
DESTINATION NUMBER TRANSCODE  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
001=VTR001 P  
005=VTR005  
009=VCR101  
013=NETA001  
017=.......  
021=.......  
025=.......  
029=.......  
033=.......  
002=VTR002  
006=VTR006  
010=VCR102  
014=NETA002  
018=.......  
022=.......  
026=.......  
030=.......  
034=.......  
003=VTR003 P  
007=VTR007  
011=VCR103  
015=NETA003  
019=.......  
023=.......  
027=.......  
031=.......  
035=.......  
004=VTR004  
008=VTR008  
012=VCR104  
016=NETA004  
020=.......  
024=.......  
028=.......  
032=.......  
036=.......  
[F3] : Pg Up  
When [F3] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines previous to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F4] : Pg Dn  
When [F4] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines next to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
0=VTR 1=VCR  
2=AUX 3=FLM 4=TEST 5=STU 6=CAM  
7=REM  
8=CG  
9=NETA A=ENG B=ED C=FS D=SS E=BARS F=PHAN  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn P:PROT. Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
D: SET SOURCE NAME  
Purpose  
Setting Procedure (Secret Function)  
1. Select the source name using the cursor, and press [S].  
“S” is displayed after the source name, and the secret  
is set. Secret cannot be set for a number whose source  
name has not been assigned.  
2. To release the secret function, select the source name  
and press [S] once again.  
This menu is used to set the source name and secret  
function (inhibition of source selection with a remote  
control unit).  
A number between 001 to 999 and a type name set at the  
menu item [B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE] can be set to  
each source name. Description name can be set by  
changing the name mode at menu item [J : NAME  
STYLE] in the menu. For details of setting the name,  
refer to [J] in the menu.  
When the password is required, input the password  
and press [Enter]. The secret will be released.  
n
The secret function is necessary when a source signal  
should not be taken. When secret is set, remote control  
units cannot select the source signal.  
For details on password settings, refer to the menu item [P  
: CHANGE PASSWORD].  
SOURCE NUMBER TRANSCODE  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
001=VTR001  
005=VTR005  
009=AUX001 S  
013=CG001  
002=VTR002  
003=VTR003  
007=VCR101  
011=CAM001 S  
015=SS001  
004=VTR004  
008=VCR102 S  
012=CAM002  
016=BARS001  
020=.......  
024=.......  
028=.......  
032=.......  
036=.......  
Setting Procedure (Source Name)  
1. Select menu item [D].  
2. Press the cursor keys or the function keys, to select the  
source number.  
3. When [Ctrl] _ [P] is pressed, the source name will be  
deleted.  
006=VTR006  
010=AUX002  
014=NETA001  
018=.......  
022=.......  
026=.......  
030=.......  
034=.......  
017=.......  
021=.......  
025=.......  
029=.......  
033=.......  
019=.......  
023=.......  
027=.......  
031=.......  
035=.......  
0=VTR  
8=CG  
1=VCR  
2=AUX  
A=ENG  
3=FLM  
B=ED  
4=TEST  
C=FS  
5=STU  
D=SS  
6=CAM  
7=REM  
4. When [Enter] is pressed, the source name can be  
typed. If [Enter] is pressed before entering a name,  
the registration will be deleted and the cursor moves to  
the next position.  
9=NETA  
E=BARS F=PHAN  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn S:SECRET Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
5. Select the code assigned to each type name, and use  
the numerical keys to enter the source name.  
6. When [Enter] is pressed, the source name will be set  
and the cursor moves to the next position.  
If [Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed before the setting, the  
original source name will be returned.  
7. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen will be  
displayed.  
n
1. The same name cannot be given to assigned to two or  
more sources. If this is done, an error message will be  
displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
Example: “VTR001 is used already; Ignored”  
source name  
2. When the Description name is selected at menu item  
[J], the screen will display the Description name in  
addition to the “Type + Number” name.  
In this menu, the Description name is used for settings.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
Operating Function Keys  
[F1] : SEARCH (To move the cursor to the desired source  
name)  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input SOURCE  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the source name to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired source name.  
n
When menu item [J] is set to the Description name  
mode, [F1] (SEARCH) will have the following  
functions.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input * * * *  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Enter the Description name (within seven  
characters) from the head.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the Description name  
entered will be searched.  
4. If the desired name does not exist in the screen,  
press [F1] again.  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the source number)  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input SOURCE  
NUMBER=” will be displayed.  
2. Input the source number to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
[F3] : Pg Up  
When [F3] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines previous to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F4] : Pg Dn  
When [F4] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines next to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
E : SET LEVEL TABLE  
Purpose  
Operating Function Keys  
This menu is used to assign the level name and the level to  
each destination name. Up to eight levels can be set.  
In this menu, set only the necessary levels. If levels which  
have not actually been used are set, the response of the  
routing switcher system will become slower. Delete all  
levels not needed.  
[F1] : SEARCH (To move the cursor to the desired  
destination name)  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination name to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired destination name.  
After setting this menu item, the selected levels can be  
checked by remote control unit.  
n
Setting Procedure (Setting of Level Names)  
1. Select menu item [E].  
2. Press the cursor keys or the function keys to select the  
level number 1 to 8.  
When menu item [J] is set to the Description name  
mode, [F1] (SEARCH) will have the following  
functions.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the level name can be  
assigned.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input NAME =”  
will be displayed.  
4. Enter the level name using the alphabet and numerical  
keys (within four characters).  
5. When [Enter] is pressed, the level name will be set.  
If [Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed before the setting, the  
original level name will be returned.  
2. Enter the Description name (within seven  
characters) from the head.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the Description name  
entered will be searched.  
4. If the desired name does not exist in the screen,  
press [F1] again.  
6. When [Ctrl] _ [Z] is pressed, the level 1 to 8 will be  
assigned to all destination names.  
7. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen will be  
returned.  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the number of the  
desired destination)  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NUMBER =”, will be displayed.  
Setting Procedure (Level Setting . Release)  
1. Select menu item [E].  
2. Use the cursor keys to select the destination level.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the level name will be  
deleted and displayed as “ · · · · ” and the level setting  
will be released.  
2. Input the destination number to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired destination number.  
4. You can search the level with the function keys.  
n
If the destination name is not set, the number of the  
LEVEL TABLE  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
destination will not be displayed.  
1=VID 2=A1 3=A2 4=4  
VID  
5=5  
5
6=6  
6
7=7  
7
8=8  
8
No. out  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
001 OUT001 VID  
002 OUT002 VID  
003 OUT003 VID  
004 OUT004 VID  
005 OUT005 VID  
006 OUT006 VID  
007 OUT007 VID  
008 OUT008 VID  
009 OUT009 VID  
010 OUT010 VID  
011 OUT011 VID  
012 OUT012 VID  
013 OUT013 VID  
014 OUT014 VID  
015 OUT015 VID  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
0=IN  
1=OUT 2=.... 3=.... 4=.... 5=.... 6=.... 7=....  
8=.... 9=.... A=.... B=.... C=.... D=.... E=.... F=....  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
G: UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is used to enable the units connected to the S-  
BUS data link to communicate.  
This menu is used to copy the table data stored in the main  
CPU board of the primary station to the backup CPU  
board.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [F].  
This setting is valid only when the backup CPU board is  
installed in the primary station.  
2. Press the cursor keys to select the secondary station  
whose communication will be valid.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the setting displayed will  
change (“E” blank “E”). Only the secondary  
stations displayed with “E” are valid. (“M” indicates  
the primary station.)  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [G]. The message “This process  
requires about n minutes. Execute? (y/n)” will be  
displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
Ver. 2.00 : n=5  
4. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen will be  
displayed.  
Ver. 1.00 : n=7  
2. Table data copying is performed when [Y] is pressed.  
To cancel copying, press [N].  
n
3. After copying, “PROGRAM TABLE? (y/n)” may be  
displayed at the bottom of the screen. In this case,  
press [Y].  
As the response will become slower if there are many  
secondary stations, make the secondary stations not  
connected invalid.  
*” indicates out of the control area.  
m
1. The ROM version of the main CPU board and that of  
the backup CPU board must be the same. If different  
versions are used, the unit may hang up due to copy-  
ing. Remove the backup CPU board when this occurs.  
The above occurs because a new table data can not be  
run on the old version software.  
2. It takes about seven minutes to copy the table data.  
The copy makes other operations slow.  
3. The table data of transcode from RS-422A to S-BUS  
(set at the menu item [U] of a secondary station) is not  
copied to the backup CPU board.  
ENABLE ACTIVE UNIT FOR STATION NUMBER DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
1 2 3 4 5  
+
6 7 8 9 10 1112131415 1617181920  
001-020  
021-040  
041-060  
061-080  
081-100  
101-120  
121-140  
141-160  
161-180  
181-200  
201-220  
221-240  
241-254  
M E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
*
*
*
*
*
*
4. When you copy the data of main CPU to backup CPU  
on the menu screen [G : UPDATE BACKUP CON-  
TROLLER] of the primary station or a secondary  
station, you can abort the operation by pressing [Ctrl]  
_ [D].  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
m
However you should copy again for the data of the  
backup CPU is not correct if aborted. Even if you do  
not copy again, the data will be renewed in one hour  
approximately by the auto backup function.  
1. Station ID of the primary station is always regardless  
of the DIP switch setting on the CPU board.  
2. Station ID of the secondary station is deter mined with  
the DIP switch setting. Do not assign the same  
number on two or more units as station ID on both  
standard S-BUS and monitor S-BUS.  
Number that can be registered as secondary station ID  
are 2 to 254.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
H: SET GLOBAL PHANTOM  
The phantom function switches several crosspoints  
together with one button pushing of a remote control unit.  
The crosspoints of different levels can be also switched  
with this function.  
Operating Function Keys  
(Global Phantom Display)  
[F1] : SEARCH (To move the cursor to the desired global  
phantom name)  
There are two kinds of phantoms such as local phantom  
and global phantom (refer to the menu item [H : SET  
PHANTOM TABLE] of secondary stations for local  
phantom).  
In local phantom function, the phantom data is stored in a  
remote control unit, and the phantom name is assigned  
only on this remote control unit. In global phantom  
function, however, the phantom data is stored in the  
primary station, and it can be called by any remote control  
unit. The global phantom function can be set only when  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-V3232 is  
assigned as the primary station.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input PHAN-  
TOM NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the global phantom name to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired name.  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the desired global  
phantom number)  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input PHAN-  
TOM NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the global phantom to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
The following describes how to set the global phantom  
data in the primary station. A maximum of 4095 cross-  
points can be registered.  
[F3] : Pg Up  
When [F3] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines previous to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F4] : Pg Dn  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [H]. The global phantom list will be  
displayed.  
2. Select any global phantom number with the cursor or  
function key and press [Enter]. The edit screen will  
be displayed.  
When [F4] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines next to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen will be  
displayed.  
GLOBAL PHANTOM LIST  
No. NAME No. NAME  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
(4094 REMAIN)  
No. NAME  
No. NAME  
0001 GPHA001 0002 ....... 0003 ....... 0004 .......  
0005 ....... 0006 ....... 0007 ....... 0008 .......  
0009 ....... 0010 ....... 0011 ....... 0012 .......  
0013 ....... 0014 ....... 0015 ....... 0016 .......  
0017 ....... 0018 ....... 0019 ....... 0020 .......  
0021 ....... 0022 ....... 0023 ....... 0024 .......  
0025 ....... 0026 ....... 0027 ....... 0028 .......  
0029 ....... 0030 ....... 0031 ....... 0032 .......  
0033 ....... 0034 ....... 0035 ....... 0036 .......  
0037 ....... 0038 ....... 0039 ....... 0040 .......  
0041 ....... 0042 ....... 0043 ....... 0044 .......  
0045 ....... 0046 ....... 0047 ....... 0048 .......  
0049 ....... 0050 ....... 0051 ....... 0052 .......  
0053 ....... 0054 ....... 0055 ....... 0056 .......  
0057 ....... 0058 ....... 0059 ....... 0060 .......  
0061 ....... 0062 ....... 0063 ....... 0064 .......  
0=IN  
1=OUT 2=.... 3=.... 4=.... 5=.... 6=.... 7=....  
8=.... 9=.... A=.... B=.... C=.... D=.... E=.... F=GPHA  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Global Phantom Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
3. As the cursor is placed where the name is typed, press  
[Enter]. The input mode will be set.  
Operating Function Keys  
(Global Phantom Edit Display)  
[F1] : SEARCH (To move the cursor to any source name  
or destination name)  
4. Select the codes assigned to each type name and enter  
any number using the cursor. Press [Enter] key to set  
it. Press [Ctrl] _ [P] to delete the phantom name.  
5. Move the cursor to the place to input the destination  
and press [Enter]. The input mode will be set.  
6. Input the destination name with the alphabet or  
numerical keys and press [Enter] to set it.  
n
When menu item [J] is set to the Description name  
mode, [F1] (SEARCH) will have the following  
functions.  
7. Input the source name in the same way as  
setting the destination name and press [Enter].  
8. Set the crosspoint level. Move the cursor to  
desired level and press [Enter]. The setting will be  
changed.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input NAME =”  
will be displayed.  
2. Enter the Description name (within seven  
characters) from the head.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the Description name  
entered will be searched.  
Press [Ctrl] _ [E]. The menu will return.  
4. If the desired name does not exist in the screen,  
press [F1] again.  
EDIT GLOBAL PHANTOM  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
(4094 REMAIN)  
0001 GPHA001  
LEVEL: 1=VID 2=A1 3=A2 4=4  
.... .... ....  
5=5  
6=6  
7=7  
8=8  
[F2] : ADD (To add the row of crosspoints to be regis-  
OUT001 <IN001 VID  
OUT002 <IN002 VID  
OUT003 <IN001 VID  
OUT004 <IN001 VID  
OUT005 <IN001 VID  
OUT006 <IN001 VID  
OUT007 <IN001 VID  
OUT008 <IN001 VID  
OUT009 <IN001 VID  
OUT010 <IN001 VID  
OUT011 <IN001 VID  
OUT012 <IN001 VID  
OUT013 <IN001 VID  
OUT014 <IN001 VID  
OUT015 <IN001 VID  
OUT016 <IN001 VID  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
.... ....  
tered as the global phantom)  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
A2  
....  
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
.... .... ....  
[F3] : DELETE (To delete the crosspoints)  
1. Select the destination name to be deleted using  
the cursor.  
6
6
6
.... ....  
7
7
....  
8
.... .... ....  
.... .... ....  
.... .... ....  
.... .... ....  
.... .... ....  
.... .... ....  
.... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
.... .... .... ....  
2. Press [F3].  
[F4] : Dstlvl (To change the level of the crosspoint at the  
cursor to the level set at the menu item [E])  
1. Select the destination name to be returned to the  
initial level using the cursor.  
A1  
.... 4  
5
.... 7  
8
0=IN  
1=OUT 2=.... 3=.... 4=.... 5=.... 6=.... 7=....  
8=.... 9=.... A=.... B=.... C=.... D=.... E=.... F= GPHA  
F1:SEARCH F2:ADD F3:DELETE F4:DstLvl Ctrl-E:RETURN TO LAST MENU  
2. Press [F4].  
Example of Global Phantom Edit Screen  
n
When the name mode of menu item [J] is switched, the  
destination and source names displayed on the global  
phantom edit screen will change.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
J : NAME STYLE  
Purpose  
Operating Function Keys  
This menu is used to switch the name styles of the destina-  
tion and source.  
[F1] : SEARCH (To move the cursor to the desired  
destination name)  
The “Type + Number” name (Type + Num) or “Descrip-  
tion” name (DESCRIP. NAME) can be set.  
Names on the setting screen of menu items [C], [D], [E],  
[H], [L], [M], [N], [O], and [Q] are switched according to  
this menu.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination name to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired destination name.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [J].  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the desired destina-  
tion number)  
2. Press the alphabet key [J] and [Enter]. The message  
on the screen will change from “Type + Num” to  
“DESCRIP. NAME” each time this key are pressed.  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination number to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
. Destination name setting procedure using the  
Description name  
3. Set menu item [J] to the Description name mode.  
Ex. [J : NAME STYLE (DESCRIP. NAME)]  
4. Select menu item [C].  
5. Move the cursor to the desired destination number.  
6. When either [Enter] is pressed, the destination name  
can be typed. If the Description name is set already,  
delete it by [BS].  
[F3] : Pg Up  
When [F3] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines previous to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F4] : Pg Dn  
When [F4] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines next to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
7. Enter the Description name using the alphabet keys or  
the numerical keys. When [Enter] is pressed, the  
Description name will be set.  
[F5] : PASTE (To copy the Description name)  
1. Move the cursor to the destination number to be  
copied.  
n
2. Press [SPACE].  
Up to sixteen characters can be input. Remote control  
units except BKS-R3281 will display until the seven  
characters. As the first seven characters are also used to  
distinguish the names, the unit may not operate properly if  
the same names are assigned for the first seven characters.  
3. Move the cursor to the destination number to be  
pasted, and press [F5].  
n
Do not assign the same name to more than one destination.  
. Source name setting procedure using  
Description name  
DESTINATION NUMBER TRANSCODE  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
1.....7.........  
DST-012  
1.....7.........  
3. Set menu item [J] to the Description name mode.  
Example:[J : NAME STYLE (DESCRIP. NAME)]  
4. Select menu item [D].  
5. Move the cursor to the desired source name.  
6. When [Enter] is pressed, the Description name can be  
typed. If the Description name is set already, delete it  
by [BS].  
7. Enter the Description name using the alphabet or  
numerical keys. When [Enter] is pressed, the De-  
scription name will be set.  
001=OUT001 P  
003=OUT003  
005=OUT005  
007=OUT007  
009=OUT009  
011=OUT011  
013=OUT013  
015=OUT015  
017=OUT017 P  
019=OUT019  
021=OUT021  
023=OUT023  
025=OUT025  
027=OUT027  
029=OUT029  
031=OUT031  
| 002=OUT002  
| 004=OUT004 P  
| 006=OUT006 P  
| 008=OUT008  
| 010=OUT010 P  
| 012=OUT012  
| 014=OUT014  
| 016=OUT016  
| 018=OUT018  
Hong Kong  
Market  
Tokyo  
|
|
|
London  
New York  
Toront  
|
|
|
OUT008  
Net-1  
Net-2  
EDIT-5  
CG-B  
EDIT-2  
CG-A  
|
|
|
News-1  
Mountain  
OUT020  
OUT017  
Washington D.C. | 020=OUT020  
|
OUT021  
| 022=OUT022  
| 024=OUT024  
| 026=OUT026  
| 028=OUT028  
| 030=OUT030  
| 032=OUT032  
|
|
OUT023  
River  
OUT025  
OUT026  
OUT028  
OUT030  
OUT032  
|
|
|
|
OUT027  
Atlantic Ocean  
OUT031  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP  
F3:PgUp F4:PgDn F5:PASTE Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Destination Name Setting Screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-10  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
K: DEFAULT TABLE  
L : SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT  
Purpose  
Purpose  
Assign the physical numbers of the switcher to the destina-  
tion numbers, source numbers and the levels of the virtual  
matrix.  
This menu is used to initialize the table data. Do not  
perform this menu when modifying the table data.  
Do not assign the same number.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [K]. The message “RESET TO  
DEFAULT TABLE? (y/n)” will be displayed at the  
bottom of the screen.  
2. Initialization is performed when [Y] is pressed. To  
cancel initializing, press [N].  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [L].  
2. Each time [F5] is pressed, the setting screen will  
change as follows.  
Source number setting screen destination number  
setting screen source number setting screen.  
n
The table data will be lost when performing the menu item  
[K].  
. Source Number Setting Procedure  
3. Select the source number setting screen.  
4. Select the physical number and the level using the  
cursor, and assign them to desired source number and  
level on the virtual matrix. When [Enter] is pressed,  
the physical assignment can be typed.  
5. Enter the physical number using numerical keys, and  
press [Enter].  
6. Next, enter the physical level, and press [Enter] to set  
it.  
If press [Ctrl] _ [F] before setting, the physical  
number and level will be returned to the previous  
values.  
If the physical number and physical level to be set has  
been already used, cancel their settings first before  
setting new ones.  
To cancel, select the physical number and level to be  
canceled, and press [Ctrl] _ [P].  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
. Destination Number Setting Procedure  
Press [F5] to set the destination number setting screen.  
Then, perform the same procedure as for source.  
[F2] : JUMP {To move the cursor to the desired destina-  
tion (source) number}  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
(SOURCE) NUMBER=” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination (source) number to be  
retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
PHYSICAL NUMBER ASSIGNMENT  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
DESTINATION  
No. NAME  
LEVEL  
A1  
VID  
A2  
4
5
6
7
8
001 OUT001 001-1 001-2 017-3 001-4 001-5 001-6 032-7 ...-.  
002 OUT002 002-1 ...-. 018-3 002-4 005-5 002-6 031-7 ...-.  
003 OUT003 003-1 003-2 019-3 003-4 011-5 003-6 030-7 ...-.  
004 OUT004 004-1 004-2 020-3 004-4 ...-. 004-6 ...-. ...-.  
005 OUT005 005-1 005-2 ...-. 005-4 021-5 005-6 028-7 ...-.  
006 OUT006 006-1 006-2 ...-. 006-4 026-5 006-6 027-7 ...-.  
007 OUT007 007-1 007-2 ...-. ...-. ...-. 007-6 ...-. ...-.  
008 OUT008 008-1 008-2 ...-. ...-. 036-5 008-6 025-7 ...-.  
009 OUT009 009-1 009-2 ...-. ...-. 041-5 009-6 024-7 ...-.  
010 OUT010 001-8 010-2 ...-. ...-. 046-5 010-6 023-7 ...-.  
011 OUT011 002-8 011-2 ...-. ...-. 051-5 011-6 022-7 ...-.  
012 OUT012 003-8 012-2 ...-. ...-. ...-. 012-6 021-7 ...-.  
013 OUT013 004-8 013-2 ...-. ...-. 013-5 013-6 ...-. ...-.  
014 OUT014 005-8 014-2 ...-. ...-. 014-5 014-6 ...-. ...-.  
015 OUT015 006-8 015-2 ...-. ...-. ...-. 015-6 ...-. ...-.  
016 OUT016 007-8 016-2 ...-. ...-. ...-. 016-6 017-7 ...-.  
017 OUT017 008-8 ...-. ...-. ...-. 017-5 017-6 016-7 ...-.  
018 OUT018 009-8 ...-. ...-. ...-. 018-5 018-6 015-7 ...-.  
[F3] : Pg Up  
When [F3] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines previous to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F4] : Pg Dn  
When [F4] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines next to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F5] : SOURCE (DEST.)  
When [F5] is pressed, the number setting screen  
will change between the destination number setting  
screen and source number setting screen alternately.  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn F5:SOURCE Ctrl-P:DELETE Ctrl-E:MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
m
1. The physical number is the input/output number  
specified at the menu item [A : SET UNIT LOCA-  
TION].  
2. The virtual input/output name and the virtual level  
name are assigned to the buttons on the remote control  
unit.  
Operating Function Keys  
[F1] : SEARCH {To move the cursor to the desired  
destination (source) name}  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
(SOURCE) NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination (source) name to be  
retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired name.  
n
When menu item [J] is set to the Description name  
mode, [F1] (SEARCH) will have the following  
functions.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input NAME  
=” will be displayed.  
2. Enter the Description name (within seven  
characters) from the head.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the Description name  
entered will be searched.  
4. If the desired name does not exist in the screen,  
press [F1] again.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
M: SET INHIBIT TABLE  
Purpose  
Operating Function Keys  
This menu is used to protect source numbers not to be  
selected for each destination.  
[F1] : SEARCH (To move the cursor to the desired  
destination name)  
When the secret function is set to a source name, the  
selected source cannot be output to all destinations. By  
using this menu, source numbers to be inhibited can be  
assigned for each destination.  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination name to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired name.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [M].  
n
2. Select the source number for each destination name  
using the cursor. When [Enter] is pressed, the setting  
will be switched.  
When menu item [J] is set to the Description name  
mode, [F1] (SEARCH) will have the following  
functions.  
x” : Connectable crosspoint  
_” : Unconnectable crosspoint  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input NAME =”  
will be displayed.  
2. Enter the Description name (within seven  
characters) from the head.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the Description name  
entered will be searched.  
SET INHIBIT TABLE  
DEST. SOURCE  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
001  
01--08  
09--16  
17--24  
25--32  
33--40  
41--48  
49--56  
57--64  
OUT001 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT002 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT003 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xx----xx xxxx---x xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT004 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xx----xx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT005 xxx-xxxx xxxxxxxx x------- -------- xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxx---x  
OUT006 xxxxxxxx xxx-xxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT007 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx x------- xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT008 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xx------ xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxx-- ------xx xxxxxxxx  
DEST. SOURCE  
4. If the desired name does not exist in the screen,  
press [F1] again.  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the desired destina-  
tion number)  
009  
01--08  
09--16  
17--24  
25--32  
33--40  
41--48  
49--56  
57--64  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination number to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
OUT009 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT010 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xx------ -----xxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT011 xxxxx-xx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xx------ -----xxx xxxxxxxx xx--xxxx  
OUT012 xxxx-xxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT013 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx x---xxxx --xxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT014 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx x---xxxx --xxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT015 xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
OUT016 xxxxxxxx xxxx--xx xxxx-xxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
F1:SEARCH  
F2:JUMP  
F3:LEFT  
F4:RIGHT  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
[F3] : LEFT (To scroll to the next 64 sources on the left)  
[F4] : RIGHT (To scroll to the next 64 sources on the  
right)  
Example of Setting Screen  
n
The setting area for this menu is 512 x 512. Set this  
function (crosspoint disable setting function) within the  
size specified for the system used.  
Excess crosspoints will be ignored automatically.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
N: SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP  
Purpose  
Operating Function Keys  
To register the Description names required for each remote  
control unit, set the group of Description names. Up to  
eight such source and destination groups can be set.  
(Up to 160 names can be registered for one group.)  
The top half of the screen is for setting the group and the  
bottom half displays the list of Description names.  
[F1] : MOVE  
(To move the cursor up and down between the  
group setting screen and Description name list)  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the desired element  
number)  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input ELE-  
MENT NUMBER =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the element number to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [N].  
2. Move the cursor to the group number by pressing [B].  
3. Enter the group number using the numerical keys, and  
press [Enter] to set it.  
4. Press [F1] to move the cursor to the lower side of  
screen.  
5. Select a number and press [Enter]. The Description  
name will be copied to the space of the lowest number  
on the group setting screen.  
[F3] : SOURCE (DEST.)  
When [F3] is pressed, the Description name list  
will be changed from destination to source.  
[B] : GROUP  
Press [B] to move the cursor to the group number  
on the group setting screen.  
To erase the Description names on the group setting  
screen, move the cursor to the number and press [BS],  
[DEL] or [Ctrl] _ [P].  
[L] : COPY (To copy all data in the Description name  
group to other groups)  
DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
1. When [L] is pressed, the message “Please Input  
Original Group Number =” will be displayed  
to ask for the group number to be copied.  
2. Input the group number to be copied with the  
numerical keys and press [Enter]. The data of  
all group will be copied to the group setting  
screen currently displayed.  
GROUP 1 160 REMAIN  
001 .......  
003 .......  
005 .......  
007 .......  
009 .......  
011 .......  
013 .......  
015 .......  
002 .......  
004 .......  
006 .......  
008 .......  
010 .......  
012 .......  
014 ......  
016 .......  
==================================================================  
[S] : SEND (Transfers all data on the group setting  
screen currently displayed to a secondary station)  
1. When [S] is pressed, a message “Please Input  
Station Number =” will be displayed to ask for  
the number of a secondary station to which the  
data is to be transferred.  
001=OUT001  
003=OUT003  
005=OUT005  
007=OUT007  
009=OUT009  
011=OUT011  
013=OUT013  
015=OUT015  
OUT001  
OUT003  
OUT005  
OUT007  
OUT009  
OUT011  
OUT013  
OUT015  
002=OUT002  
004=OUT004  
006=OUT006  
008=OUT008  
010=OUT010  
012=OUT012  
014=OUT014  
016=OUT016  
OUT002  
OUT004  
OUT006  
OUT008  
OUT010  
OUT012  
OUT014  
OUT016  
F1:MOVE  
F2:JUMP F3:SOURCE B:Group L:Copy S:Send Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
2. Input the number of the secondary station using  
the numerical keys and press [Enter].  
All data on the group setting screen currently  
displayed will be transferred to the secondary  
station.  
Example of Setting Screen  
m
1. In the remote control unit, the transferred data are all  
displayed as input/output numbers.  
This is because data is transferred using input/output  
numbers instead of input/output names.  
2. The group data of the primary and secondary stations’  
must be always the same.  
If the primary station data is changed after transfer, be  
sure to transfer the new data to the secondary station.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
. Transferring Data to the Secondary Station on  
the Monitor S-BUS  
To transfer the data on the group setting screen currently  
displayed to a secondary station on the monitor S-BUS, the  
number of the primary station on the monitor S-BUS must  
be specified, in addition to the secondary station number.  
Specify in the following way.  
Please Input Station Number = [||||||] _ [||||||]  
Station number of the  
primary station on  
monitor S-BUS  
Station number of the  
secondary station on  
monitor S-BUS  
. Transferring Data to All Secondary Stations  
Press [A] instead of entering station numbers. The  
groupsetting data currently displayed will be transferred to  
all secondary stations including the monitor S-BUS.  
n
If a Description name is not in a secondary station, then,  
when in Description name mode, the source or destination  
name will be the corresponding Type + Num. name.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
O: SET TIE LINES  
Purpose  
4. Input the source number using the numerical keys and  
press [Enter] to set it. If [Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed  
before the setting, the original source name will be  
returned. When [Ctrl] _ [P] is pressed, the source  
name will be deleted and “ · · · · ” will be displayed.  
5. After setting the source group, press [F5]. The top  
half of the screen will be switched to the destination  
group setting screen.  
This menu is used to store the connection information of the  
matrix in the primary station and to set the tie line for switching  
several crosspoints using the remote control unit button.  
Using this method, peripheral units such as the signal  
converters can be used more efficiently.  
The tie line consists of four input/output connectors as one  
group and paths connected between sources and destina-  
tions. The tie line system consists of a maximum of 20  
groups for sources and destinations respectively, and a  
maximum of 40 groups for connections, called Net groups.  
SET TIE LINES  
SOURCE GROUPS  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
S001: 010(OUT010 ) S002: ...(.......) S003: ...(.......) S004: ...(.......)  
011(OUT011 )  
012(OUT012 )  
013(OUT013 )  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
Setting Procedure  
Before you perform the tie line management using two or  
three routing switchers, you should set the unit location  
and the elements of the tie line as follows.  
1. Set the offset of each unit on the menu screen [A : SET  
UNIT LOCATION] of the secondary station in order  
to avoid repeated input/output numbers of multiple  
units and locate the units on one physical level.  
2. Set the elements of the tie line on the menu screen [O :  
SET TIE LINE].  
S005: ...(....... ) S006: ...(.......) S007: ...(.......) S008: ...(.......)  
...(....... )  
...(....... )  
...(....... )  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
===================================================================  
P01:S  
P03:S  
P05:S  
P07:S  
P09:S  
P11:S  
P13:S  
P15:S  
P17:S  
P19:S  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
P02:S  
P04:S  
P06:S  
P08:S  
P10:S  
P12:S  
P14:S  
P16:S  
P18:S  
P20:S  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
Select menu item [O].  
The top half of the screen is for setting the source group  
while the bottom half is for setting the tie line path.  
F1:MOVE F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn F5:GROUP Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Destination Group Setting Screen  
SET TIE LINES  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
6. Set the destination group in the same way as for the  
source group.  
7. After setting the destination group, press [F5] and set  
the net group setting screen.  
SOURCE GROUPS  
S001: ...(.......) S002: ...(.......) S003: ...(.......) S004: ...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
S005: ...(.......) S006: ...(.......) S007: ...(.......) S008: ...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
...(.......)  
SET TIE LINES  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
NET GROUPS  
===================================================================  
N001:  
LEVEL= 1  
2 .... .... .... .... .... ....  
P01:S  
P03:S  
P05:S  
P07:S  
P09:S  
P11:S  
P13:S  
P15:S  
P17:S  
P19:S  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
P02:S  
P04:S  
P06:S  
P08:S  
P10:S  
P12:S  
P14:S  
P16:S  
P18:S  
P20:S  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-D  
-D  
-D  
020(OUT020 )> 021(IN021 )  
023(OUT023 )> 023(IN023 )  
022(OUT022 )> 022(IN022 )  
024(OUT024 )> 024(IN024 )  
N002:  
LEVEL= .... .... 3  
4
.... .... .... ....  
-N  
-N  
-D  
025(OUT025 )> 025(IN025 )  
027(OUT027 )> 027(IN027 )  
026(OUT026 )> 026(IN026 )  
028(OUT028 )> 028(IN028 )  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
LEVEL: 1=VID 2=A1 3=A2 4=4 5=5 6=6  
7=7 8=8  
===================================================================  
P01:S  
P03:S  
P05:S  
P07:S  
P09:S  
P11:S  
P13:S  
P15:S  
P17:S  
P19:S  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
P02:S  
P04:S  
P06:S  
P08:S  
P10:S  
P12:S  
P14:S  
P16:S  
P18:S  
P20:S  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-N  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
-D  
F1:MOVE F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn F5:GROUP Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Source Group Setting Screen  
3. Select a source group number using the cursor and press  
[Enter]. The source number input mode will be set.  
Set the source name to the desired source group.  
F1:MOVE F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn F5:GROUP Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Net Group Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
8. Select the number of net group with cursor keys and  
press [Enter] to set the input mode.  
Operating Function Keys  
[F1] : MOVE  
Set the signal path between two routing switchers,  
When [F1] is pressed, the cursor will move be-  
using the combination of the  
tween upper and lower of the screen.  
“OUT of the front stage” > “IN of the latter stage”.  
9. Input the source number and the destination number  
with the numerical keys and press [Enter] to set it.  
When change the level, move the cursor to the level  
and press [Enter].  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the group number of  
the desired source)  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input  
GROUP NUMBER =” will be displayed.  
2. Input the group number of the source to be  
retrieved.  
10. Press [F1] to move the cursor to the tie line path  
setting screen.  
Set tie line paths using the combination of  
“Source group” _ “Net group” _ “Net group” _  
“Destination group”.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired number.  
The two “Net groups” can be set at a maximum.  
However, leave one “Net group” blank when there are  
two routing switchers to be connected.  
[F3] : Pg Up  
When [F3] is pressed, the top half of the screen will  
display the 6 lines previous to the 6 lines displayed  
currently.  
11. Move the cursor to a path number and press [Enter].  
The source group input mode will be set.  
12. Input the source group number and press [Enter]. The  
cursor will move to the net group. Input the net group  
and destination group in the same way as for the  
source group. Up to two net groups can be input for  
one path.  
[F4] : Pg Dn  
When [F4] is pressed, the top half of the screen will  
display the 6 lines next to the 6 lines displayed  
currently.  
[F5] : GROUP  
(To move the cursor to the top half of the screen  
and press [F5]. The display will change: “Source  
Gp” “Destination Gp” “Net Gp”.)  
[F5] : DISP  
13. Use the above procedure to assign the source, destina-  
tion and net numbers to each path number.  
(To move the cursor to the bottom half of the screen  
and press [F5]. The display will change : “Path” →  
“Source Name” “Destination Name”.)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
P : CHANGE PASSWORD  
Q: CHANGE CROSSPOINT  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is used to display the crosspoints and change  
them.  
This menu is used to change the password.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [P].  
2. Input the password currently set, and press [Enter].  
In the default status, password is not set in DVS-  
V3232B/V6464B.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [Q].  
2. Select the item using the cursor. Change only the  
source name.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the source name input mode  
will be set. When either key is pressed before entering  
the source name, the mode will be canceled and the  
previous display will be returned.  
4. Select the code assigned to each type name, and enter  
the source name using the numerical keys.  
5. When [Enter] is pressed, the crosspoint will be set. If  
[Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed before the setting, the original  
setting will be returned.  
Once the password is set, the menu items can not be  
set or changed unless the password is entered.  
If a wrong password is input, the demand for password  
input will be displayed again.  
3. Enter a new password, and press [Enter]. The new  
password is verified again.  
4. After the new password has been confirmed twice, the  
screen will return to the menu screen.  
When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen will be  
displayed.  
5. If not confirmed, the password is demanded again.  
CHANGE PASSWORD  
Please Input New Password = ________________*  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
m
1. When the power of the primary station is  
turned on, “ · · · · ” will be displayed for a while at the  
source name position. But once the status of the cross-  
points is detected, the source name set before hand will  
be displayed.  
Example of Setting Screen  
n
2. Outputs whose destination names are not assigned will  
be displayed with “ · · · · ”, and crosspoint switching  
cannot be performed for these.  
If you forget the password, settings cannot be performed  
unless the unit is returned to default.  
3. Moreover, names set with the protect function cannot  
be switched either.  
4. When entering the Description name, enter 7 charac-  
ters from the head.  
As all table data will be erased when returned to default, be  
sure you should not forget the password.  
CHANGE CROSSPOINT  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
LEVEL=1  
DEST  
SOURCE DEST  
SOURCE  
DEST  
SOURCE  
DEST  
SOURCE  
OUT001 -IN001  
OUT005 -IN005  
OUT009 -IN009  
OUT013 -IN013  
OUT017 -IN017  
OUT021 -IN021  
OUT025 -IN025  
OUT029 -IN029  
OUT033 -IN033  
OUT037 -IN037  
OUT041 -IN041  
OUT045 -IN045  
OUT049 -IN049  
OUT053 -IN053  
OUT057 -IN057  
OUT061 -IN061  
OUT002 -IN002  
OUT006 -IN006  
OUT010 -IN010  
OUT014 -IN014  
OUT018 -IN018  
OUT022 -IN022  
OUT026 -IN026  
OUT030 -IN030  
OUT034 -IN034  
OUT038 -IN038  
OUT042 -IN042  
OUT046 -IN046  
OUT050 -IN050  
OUT054 -IN054  
OUT058 -IN058  
OUT062 -IN062  
OUT003 -IN003  
OUT007 -IN007  
OUT011 -IN011  
OUT015 -IN015  
OUT019 -IN019  
OUT023 -IN023  
OUT027 -IN027  
OUT031 -IN031  
OUT035 -IN035  
OUT039 -IN039  
OUT043 -IN043  
OUT047 -IN047  
OUT051 -IN051  
OUT055 -IN055  
OUT059 -IN059  
OUT063 -IN063  
OUT004 -IN004  
OUT008 -IN008  
OUT012 -IN012  
OUT016 -IN016  
OUT020 -IN020  
OUT024 -IN024  
OUT028 -IN028  
OUT032 -IN032  
OUT036 -IN036  
OUT040 -IN040  
OUT044 -IN044  
OUT048 -IN048  
OUT052 -IN052  
OUT056 -IN056  
OUT060 -IN060  
OUT064 -IN064  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
2=.... 3=.... 4=....  
5=....  
D=....  
6=....  
E=....  
7=....  
F=GPHA  
8=.... 9=.... A=.... B=.... C=....  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn F5:Level Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
Operating Function Keys  
[F2] : JUMP (To move the cursor to the desired destina-  
tion number)  
[F1] : SEARCH (To select a destination name)  
1. When [F1] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NAME =” will be displayed.  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “Please Input DEST  
NUMBER =“ will be displayed.  
2. Input the destination name to be retrieved.  
In the Description name mode, input the  
Description name (within seven characters)  
from the head.  
2. Input the destination number to be retrieved.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the cursor will move  
to the desired destination number.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the destination name  
entered will be searched.  
4. If the desired name does not exist in the screen,  
press [F1] again.  
[F3] : Pg Up  
When [F3] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines previous to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F4] : Pg Dn  
When [F4] is pressed, the screen will display the 16  
lines next to the 16 lines displayed currently.  
[F5] : LEVEL  
n
If there are several names whose typed characters are the  
same in the Description name mode, move the cursor to the  
first name displayed and press [Enter] to continue moving  
the cursor to the next name.  
When [F5] is pressed, a level can be selected.  
Select the level number using the numerical key and  
press [Enter]. If [A] is pressed instead of the  
numerical key and press [Enter] here, the screen  
will display a list of all levels. Thefunction keys  
[F1], [F2], and [F5] on the ALL screen have the  
same functions as those of the initial screen menu  
item [Q].  
[F1] : SEARCH (To select a source name)  
In the Description name mode, the setting proce-  
dure is as follows.  
1. When [Enter] is pressed, the source input  
mode will be set.  
CHANGE CROSSPOINT  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
LEVEL=ALL  
2. Input the desired Description name (within  
seven characters) from the head.  
LEVEL:  
1=VID  
No. out  
2=A1  
3=A2  
4=4  
5=5  
6=6  
7=7  
8=8  
3. Every time [F1] is pressed, the desired name  
will be searched.  
4. When the desired name is displayed, press  
Return or Enter to set the crosspoint.  
001 OUT001 IN001  
002 OUT002 IN002  
003 OUT003 IN003  
004 OUT004 IN004  
005 OUT005 IN005  
006 OUT006 IN006  
007 OUT007 IN007  
008 OUT008 IN008  
009 OUT009 IN009  
010 OUT010 IN010  
011 OUT011 IN011  
012 OUT012 IN012  
013 OUT013 IN013  
014 OUT014 IN014  
015 OUT015 IN015  
016 OUT016 IN016  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
IN004  
IN005  
IN006  
IN007  
IN008  
IN009  
IN010  
IN011  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN016  
IN017  
IN018  
IN019  
IN020  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
IN015  
IN016  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
IN004  
IN005  
IN006  
IN007  
IN008  
IN009  
IN010  
IN011  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN016  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
.....  
IN005  
IN006  
IN007  
IN008  
.....  
IN010  
IN011  
IN012  
.....  
IN014  
IN015  
IN016  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
IN004  
IN005  
IN006  
IN007  
IN008  
IN009  
IN010  
IN011  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN016  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
.....  
IN005  
IN006  
IN007  
IN008  
IN009  
IN010  
IN011  
IN012  
.....  
IN014  
IN015  
IN016  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
.....  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
2=....  
A=....  
3=....  
B=....  
4=....  
C=....  
5=....  
D=....  
6=....  
E=....  
7=....  
F=GPHA  
8=....  
9=....  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F5:Level  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
S : SELECT INDICATION COLOR  
(Except for BKPF-R70 and HDS-V3232)  
Purpose  
This menu is used to call the menu of the secondary station  
connected to the S-BUS of the primary station.  
Purpose  
If this menu is set to “ON”, the screen will show a color  
display during the use of the Sony control terminal BAC-  
1200.  
Operating Procedure  
1. Select the menu item [R] at the menu screen.  
A message will be displayed on the screen.  
2. Enter the station number of the secondary station, and  
press [Enter]. The display will be changed to the  
menu screen of the secondary station.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [S].  
2. When [S], [Enter] is pressed, the setting condition  
displayed will be switched (“ON” “OFF” ”ON”  
...).  
3. If [Ctrl] _ [D] is pressed, the screen will return to the  
menu screen of the primary station.  
n
m
As wrong characters will be displayed before and after the  
menu items when a control terminal except Sony control  
terminal BAC-1200 is used, be sure to set to “OFF”.  
1. If the specified secondary station does not exist on the  
S-BUS data link, the following message will be  
displayed.  
Display: “Station dose not exist”  
2. If the specified secondary station is not  
available for communication, the following message  
will be displayed.  
T : SET CLOCK  
Purpose  
Check at the menu item [F : SET ACTIVE UNIT  
NUMBER].  
Display: “Disable Station”  
This menu is used for the setting of the time. The time set  
at this menu will be used for recording the time of error  
occurrence.  
CALL STATION NUMBER ?  
Setting Procedure  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
1. Select menu item [T].  
2. Enter the time using the numerical keys, and press  
Setting Screen  
[Enter] to set it.  
The screen will be changed to the menu screen  
automatically.  
n
If [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed without pressing [Enter], the  
screen will return to the menu screen and the setting  
modification becomes invalid.  
1993.02.03-22:24(Y.M.D-H:M) READ TIME  
CHANGE TO = 1993.02.03-22:24  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
U: SELECT REMOTE  
Purpose  
n
This menu is used to control the routing switcher using the  
9-pin remote (REMOTE 2), and to set the control mode to  
the DIRECT mode or the S-BUS conversion mode.  
How to use UA2 Code:  
The original use of the UA2 code in the RS-422A protocol  
is to identify the multiple equipments which are connected  
by loop-through connection, and be controlled.  
Each equipment is controlled by the control command with  
UA2 code which corresponds to the unit address of each  
equipment.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [U].  
2. Select channel using the cursor keys.  
3. Press [Enter], and the setting condition displayed will  
be changed.  
The UA2 code is converted to the level control command  
when the RS-422A commands are converted to the S-BUS  
levels.  
DIRECT CONVERT RS422 (CART +) to S-BUS  
SELECT CONTROL MODE  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
The following examples show how UA2 codes are con-  
verted to the S-BUS level.  
CHANNEL A --- REMOTE FUNCTION = CONVERT RS422(CART+) to S-BUS  
CHANNEL B --- REMOTE FUNCTION = DIRECT  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
UA2 = 01 00000001 S-BUS level 1  
UA2 = 02 00000010 S-BUS level 2  
UA2 = 04 00000100 S-BUS level 3  
UA2 = 08 00001000 S-BUS level 4  
UA2 = 10 00010000 S-BUS level 5  
UA2 = 20 00100000 S-BUS level 6  
UA2 = 40 01000000 S-BUS level 7  
UA2 = 80 10000000 S-BUS level 8  
UA2 = FF 11111111 S-BUS All level  
Example of Setting Screen  
DIRECT:  
In this mode commands received using RS-422A are not  
converted to those for the S-BUS (REMOTE 1) and are  
directly used for controlling the receiving station. If this  
mode is selected, a protocol must be selected at the  
secondary station.  
The following combinations of levels are also possible.  
CONVERT RS-422 (CART +) to S-BUS  
This mode converts commands received using the RS-  
422A to those for the S-BUS.  
UA2 = 03 00000011 S-BUS level 1 and 2  
UA2 = 07 00000111 S-BUS level 1, 2 and 3  
n
The S-BUS conversion mode can be used only when the  
primary station is controlled by the 9-pin remote control.  
Therefore, use the DIRECT mode whenever a secondary  
station is controlled by the 9-pin remote control.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
V : SELECT WARNING DISPLAY  
Purpose  
n
This menu is used to set the warning message displayed on  
the system status screen.  
Some messages will not be displayed, depending on the  
models.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [V].  
2. Press [V], [Enter], and the setting conditions dis-  
played will be switched.(“ON” “OFF”).  
“OFF” : Displays important messages only  
<Reference>  
“X-POINT ERROR IN STATION * *”  
“X-POINT RECOVERED IN STATION * *”  
“TEMPERATURE RISE IN STATION * *”  
“TEMPERATURE RECOVERED IN STATION * *”  
“FAN STOP IN STATION * *”  
“FAN RECOVERED IN STATION * *”  
“S-BUS LINK DISCONNECTED TO CHANNEL”  
“S-BUS LINK CONNECTED TO CHANNEL”  
“ON” : Displays all messages  
Displays the following in addition to the above  
<Reference>  
“BACKUP POWER SUPPLY DOWN IN STATION  
* *”  
“BACKUP POWER SUPPLY RECOVERED IN  
STATION * *”  
“MISSING REFERENCE SIGNAL IN STATION * *”  
“REFERENCE SIGNAL CORRECTLY FED TO  
STATION * *”  
“VALID INPUT OR OUTPUT BOARD IN STA-  
TION * *”  
“INVALID INPUT OR OUTPUT BOARD IN STA-  
TION * *”  
“BACKUP CPU DOWN IN STATION * *”  
“BACKUP CPU RECOVERED IN STATION * *”  
“STATION * * FAILURE (DISCONNECTED OR  
POWER DOWN)”  
“STARTED BY DVS-V6464B Ver1.00 IN STATION  
* *”  
“DIFFERENT CHECK SUM=35DB IN STATION * *”  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
W:SYSTEM STATUS LOG  
X : DISPLAY S-BUS COMMUNICATION  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is used to check the error during self-diagnosis  
of each station, the status of the S-BUS circuit, and the  
time of events.  
This menu is used to display the S-BUS data received at  
the primary station.  
Setting Procedure  
SYSTEM STATUS LOG  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
1. Select menu item [X].  
2. To stop the scroll, press [Ctrl] _ [E]. (“TRACE  
OFF” will be displayed at the bottom of the screen.)  
3. The menu screen will be returned when [Ctrl] _ [E] is  
pressed again.  
1990.10.12-15:42 S-BUS LINK DISCONNECTED  
1990.10.27-09:28 STARTED BY BKS-R1601 Ver3.10 IN STATION 11  
1990.11.03-05:31 STARTED BY BKS-R3204 Ver3.11 IN STATION 32  
1991.01.14-13:51 MISSING REFERENCE SIGNAL IN STATION 1  
1991.02.01-11:15 POWER SUPPLY UNIT B DOWN IN STATION 4  
1991.02.04-06:11 X-POINT ERROR IN STATION 1  
-- end --  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
S-BUS COMMUNICATION  
TRACE ON  
Example of Display  
STATION No.011 01 01 0B 03 0E 00 08  
STATION No.015 01 09 0F 03 0E 00 08  
STATION No.011 01 01 0A FF 01 00 01  
STATION No.011 01 01 0F FF 01 00 01  
TRACE OFF  
Operation Procedure  
1. Select menu item [W].  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
2. When all status cannot be displayed on the screen,  
_ _ more _ _ ” will be displayed at the bottom of  
the screen. Press [SPACE] key to display the next  
status. When all status have been displayed, “_ _ end  
_ _” will be displayed.  
Example of Display  
n
For details on the contents of the display, refer to the S-  
3. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen.  
BUS Protocol Manual.  
System Status Screen  
Refer to “6. Confirmation of Function” for detail of the  
system status screen.  
n
. To erase the LOG contents in DVS-V3232B/V6464B,  
set the S3 switch on the CPU-149 board to “C” (Clear)  
and then press the S5 switch (Reset).  
After erasing, be sure to return the S3 switch to “0” and  
press the S5 switch (Reset) again.  
. To erase the LOG contents in HDS-V3232, set the S2  
switch on the CPU-251 board to “C” (Clear) and then  
press the S8 switch (Reset).  
After erasing, be sure to return the S2 switch to “0” and  
press the S8 switch (Reset) again.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-1. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
Y : DISPLAY TABLE (Except for HDS-V3232)  
Z : SET UNIT DETECTABLE  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is used to display the table data set with the  
control terminal.  
This menu is used to check the possibility of communica-  
tion of secondary stations connected to the S-BUS data  
link periodically.  
Operation Procedure  
During checking, “?” appears. After the completion of  
checking, the code number indicating the type of each  
device appears.  
If the secondary station does not communicate for a given  
period, the message below appears.  
1. Select menu item [Y]. The following message will be  
displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
Display : “DISPLAY TABLE DATA? (y/a/n)”  
2. Press [E], and the signal format (4: 2: 2/4 fsc) set for  
each input/output will be displayed in hexadecimal.  
(DVS-V* * * * series only.)  
“STATION * * * FAILURE (DISCONNECT OR POWER DOWN)”  
Station number  
Press [A], and all table data will be displayed in  
hexadecimal.  
When [N] is pressed, the table data display will be  
canceled.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select the menu item [Z].  
2. Select a secondary station you want to check using the  
cursor.  
3. Press [Enter], and “?” appears.  
To cancel “?”, press [Enter] again.  
4. Press [Ctrl] _ [E], and the display is changed to the  
menu screen to begin checking.  
3. If [SPACE] is pressed during the display, the display  
will be interrupted. When [SPACE] is pressed once  
again, the display will begin.  
4. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to stop the display. The menu  
screen will be displayed.  
5. After about ten seconds, select the menu item [Z]. If  
the secondary station is available for communication,  
“?” changes to a device code number.  
DISPLAY TABLE DATA  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
0000:49 4E 00 00 00 00 00 00 4F 55 54 00 00 00 00 00 : IN......OUT.....  
0010:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0020:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0030:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0040:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0050:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0060:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0070:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0080:56 49 44 00 00 00 00 00 41 31 00 00 00 00 00 00 : VID.....A1......  
0090:41 32 00 00 00 00 00 00 34 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : A2......4.......  
00A0:35 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 36 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : 5.......6.......  
00B0:37 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 38 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : 7.......8.......  
00C0:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
00D0:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
00E0:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 02 FF FF 10 00 00 02 : ................  
n
A secondary station to be checked should be set available  
for communication in advance at menu item [F : SET  
ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER]  
SET UNIT DETECTABLE  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
1 2 3 4 5  
6 7 8 9 10  
11 12 13 14 15  
16 17 18 19 20  
+
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
001-020  
021-040  
041-060  
061-080  
081-100  
101-120  
121-140  
141-160  
161-180  
181-200  
201-220  
221-240  
241-254  
M ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
? ? ? ? ?  
Example of Display  
n
For the contents of the table data, refer to the S-BUS  
Protocol Manual.  
*
*
*
*
*
*
01:DVS-V1616  
06:BKS-R3203  
11:DVS-TC3232 12:BKDM-5080  
16:BKS-R3280 17:BZR-1000  
02:DVS-V3232  
03:DVS-A3232  
04:BKS-R1601  
09:BKS-R5000  
14:BKS-R3205  
05:BKS-R3202  
10:DVS-RS1616  
15:BKS-R3206  
07:BKS-R3281  
08:DVS-V6464  
13:BKS-R3204  
18:DVS-V3232B 19:DVS-V6464B  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
A:SET UNIT LOCATION  
Purpose  
m
This menu is used to set the input/output location of the  
routing switcher.  
1. In the initial status (factory setting), the head number  
is set to “1”.  
2. When DVS-V3232B/V6464B, BKPF-R70 or HDS-  
V3232 is used as the primary station, input/output  
number can be set freely using the menu item [L : SET  
PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT].  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [A].  
2. Use the cursor keys ([&], [*] to select the setting  
item.  
The setting values in this menu are physical input/  
output/level numbers.  
When selecting crosspoints from the remote control  
unit, the virtual input/output/level numbers set at the  
menu item [L] are used. In the initial status of [L], the  
physical numbers equal the virtual numbers.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the offset value of the input  
number and the output number can be typed.  
4. Enter the offset value using the numerical keys.  
5. Press [Enter] to set the offset value.  
If [Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed before the setting, the  
original offset value will be returned.  
The location is assigned consecutive numbers from the  
offset value. The following table lists the input and  
output control area assigned from the head number  
consecutively.  
(Input)  
1
512  
1
Setting  
Area  
164  
101  
101  
164  
Model  
Input  
Output Setting Equivalent  
Unit  
area  
Control Control area  
area  
DVS-V6464B  
Location  
DVS-V6464B  
64  
32  
64  
32  
1 to 512  
1 to 512  
DVS-V3232B  
HDS-V3232  
512  
(Output)  
BVS-A3232  
256  
32  
1 to 256 DVS-TC3232  
BVS-V3232  
BVS-A3232  
DVS-V1616  
16  
16  
16  
1 to 512  
1 to 128  
DVS-RS1616  
128  
6. The menu screen of the secondary station will be  
displayed when [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed.  
SET UNIT LOCATION  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE No 0001-0064  
DESTINATION No 0001-0064  
LEVEL No 1  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
G:UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
Purpose  
This menu is used to copy the table data stored in the main  
CPU board of the secondary station to the backup CPU  
board.  
This setting is valid only when the optional CPU board is  
installed to the secondary station.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [G]. The message “This process  
requires about 1 minutes. Execute? (y/n)” will be  
displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
2. Table data copying is performed when [Y] is pressed.  
To cancel copying, press [N].  
3. In some software, when copying has been completed,  
“PROGRAM TABLE ok? (y/n)” may be displayed at  
the same position. In this case, press [Y].  
m
1. The ROM version of the main CPU board and that of  
the backup CPU board must be the same. If different  
versions are used, the unit may hang up due to copy-  
ing. Remove the backup CPU board when this occurs.  
The above occurs because a new table data can not be  
run on the old version software.  
2. It takes about 1 minutes to copy the table data.  
3. The table data of transcode from RS-422A to S-BUS  
(set at menu item [U] of a secondary station) is not  
copied to the backup CPU board.  
4. When you copy the data of main CPU to  
backup CPU on the menu screen [G : UPDATE  
BACKUP CONTROLLER] of the primary station or a  
secondary station, you can abort the operation by  
pressing [Ctrl] _ [D].  
However you should copy again for the data of the  
backup CPU is not correct if aborted. Even if you do  
not copy again, the data will be renewed in one hour  
approximately by the auto backup function.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
H: SET PHANTOM TABLE  
Purpose  
n
This menu is used to set PHANTOM which switchers  
several crosspoints, using the source selection button of the  
remote control unit.  
If a Description name has been set for the input/output  
number, the display of Description has priority to the  
display of “Type + Number” even if the “Type + Number”  
name is set.  
Setting Procedure  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3204 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 16  
1. Call the menu screen of the remote control unit to be set,  
using menu item [R], and then select menu item [H].  
2. Select a item using the cursor.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the phantom table can be set.  
If [Enter] is pressed before setting, the registration  
will be deleted.  
4. Input the data to the phantom table. The phantom  
function consists of the global phantom function  
registered at the primary station, the normal type of  
local phantom function registered at each remote  
control unit and the destination off set type of local  
phantom function.  
SET PHANTOM TABLE (PHANTOM:DESTINATION<SOURCE-LEVEL) (G.PHANTOM NAME:NUMBER)  
IN001 :OUT001 <IN001 -0 IN002 :OUT001 <IN002 -0 IN003 :OUT001 <IN003 -0  
IN004 :OUT001 <IN004 -0 IN005 :OUT001 <IN005 -0 IN006 :OUT001 <IN006 -0  
SONY007:OUT001 <SONY007-0 SONY008:OUT001 <SONY008-0 IN007 :OUT002 <IN001 -0  
IN008 :OUT002 <SONY020-0 IN009 :OUT002 <IN003 -0 IN010 :OUT002 <IN004 -0  
VTR005 :OUT002 <IN005 -0 VTR006 :OUT002 <IN006 -0 VTR007 :OUT002 <IN007 -0  
VTR008 :OUT002 <IN008 -0 SONY009:OUT001 <SONY009-0 SONY010:OUT001 <SONY010-0  
IN011 :OUT001 <IN011 -0 IN012 :OUT001 <IN012 -0 SONY013:OUT001 <SONY013-0  
SONY014:OUT001 <SONY014-0 SONY015:OUT001 <SONY015-0 IN016 :OUT001 <IN016 -0  
VTR009 :OUT002 <IN009 -0 VTR010 :OUT002 <IN010 -0 VTR011 :OUT002 <IN011 -0  
VTR012 :OUT002 <IN012 -0 VTR013 :OUT002 <IN013 -0 VTR014 :OUT002 <IN014 -0  
VTR015 :OUT002 <IN015 -0 VTR016 :OUT002 <SONY020-0 .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
.......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-. .......:.......<.......-.  
0
=SONY 1=VTR  
8=SL 9=L  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
2=SUP  
A=RET  
3=CB  
4=AIR  
5=ME  
6=PGM  
E=L/A  
7=CL  
B=MIX  
C=JEEP  
D=OSC  
F=REN  
. Setting the Global Phantom Function  
Input the phantom name with the type name and the  
number. Next, press [G] at destination name position.  
Lastly, input the global phantom number (four digits) set at  
the primary station.  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Ctrl-N:NAME  
G:GLOBAL PHANTOM  
Example of Setting Screen (Normal Type)  
. Setting the Local Phantom of the Destination  
Offset Type  
Enter the phantom name, source name and level number in  
the same way as the ordinary local phantom.  
When [+] is depressed while the cursor is positioned in the  
DESTINATION column, the system enters the Replace-  
ment Variable “DST + n” input mode. Enter the offset  
value “n” in this status.  
. Setting the Normal Type of Local Phantom  
Function  
a) At [J : NAME STYLE (Type + Num)] in the  
primary station menu item [J], input the type name  
(between 0 and F) and the number for the phantom  
name, destination name, source name and level  
number respectively. (When the remote control unit  
button is pressed, crosspoints with the same phan-  
tom name will be switched together.)  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3216 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 4  
SET PHANTOM TABLE (PHANTOM:DESTINATION<SOURCE-LEVEL) (G.PHANTOM NAME:NUMBER)  
PHANTOM | DEST  
| SOURCE | LEVEL1-8 | PHANTOM | DEST  
| SOURCE | LEVEL1-8  
SONY001 : OUT001 < IN001  
- 10000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
b) At [J : NAME STYLE (DESCRIP. NAME)] in the  
primary station menu item [J], input the phantom  
name and level number in the same way as a). For  
the source name and destination name, the Descrip-  
tion name and “Type + Number” name can be  
selected freely.  
Each time [Ctrl] _ [N] are pressed, the Description  
name input mode and “Type + Number” name input  
mode will be switched alternately.  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
9=CL  
2=SONY  
A=SL  
3=VTR  
B=L  
4=SUP  
C=RET  
K=AUX  
S=HD  
5=CB  
6=AIR  
E=JEEP  
M=BS  
7=ME  
Description name input mode :  
8=PGM  
G=L/A  
O=SAT  
D=MIX  
L=COV  
T=D1-  
F=OSC  
N=CS  
H=REM  
P=CG  
I=CAM  
Q=WETH  
J=STDO  
R=TEST  
Use the alphabet and numerical keys to enter seven  
characters from the head of the Description name.  
“Type + Number” name input mode :  
U=D2-  
V=SEG  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Ctrl-N:Type + Num  
G:GLOBAL PHANTOM +:DST+  
Example of Setting Screen (Destination Offset Type)  
Input in the same way as a).  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
5. When [Enter] is pressed, the phantom table will be  
set.  
6. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen of the  
secondary station will be displayed. When [Ctrl] _  
[D] is pressed, the menu screen of the primary station  
will be displayed.  
Internal Process After TAKE Button Pressing :  
When pressing the TAKE button after selecting a source/  
phantom the following internal process is made. In BKS-  
R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210, TAKE is processed immedi-  
ately by pressing the source selection button.  
TAKE button is pressed  
. Execution of Phantom Function  
When the phantom function is performed by a remote  
control unit, its operation conforms to this phantom table.  
It is possible to switch with the specified level or to set ON  
(1) or OFF (0) for each level. When level “0” is set or  
when “0” is set for all levels, the level value will that set  
for the destination name specified in the phantom table.  
The indication (specified on the menu item [E : SET  
LEVEL TABLE] of the primary station) is as follows :  
[Phantom name : Output terminal name < input terminal  
name – level setting].  
Checks if the selected name exists on the phantom table  
If it exists  
If it does not exist  
Check if the data set in the  
phantom table is the global  
phantom  
YES  
NO  
Output the global  
phantom number  
Select the source/destination  
set in the phantom table  
Check if the secret or protect is set to the selected  
source and destination  
If neither  
secret nor  
protect is  
set  
If secret  
or protect  
is set  
Omit the source and destination  
to which the secret or protect is  
set  
Check the level setting of the  
remaining source and destination  
for each name.  
If the setting is 0, the level is  
transferred from the destination  
table  
Output the signal switching request  
Process nothing  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
K: DEFAULT TABLE  
L : COPY TABLE DATA  
Purpose  
This menu is used to copy the table data of the specified  
remote control unit. This applies to the remote control unit  
as follow.  
Purpose  
This menu is used to initialize the table data. Do not  
perform this menu when modifying the table data.  
. Version 3.00 or later : BKS-R1601/R3202/R3203  
/R3204/R3205/R3206  
Setting Procedure  
. Version 1.00 or later : BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210  
1. Select menu item [K]. The message “RESET TO  
DEFAULT TABLE ok ? (y/n)” will be displayed at  
the bottom of the screen.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [L]. This item can be selected from  
both the menu and another setting screen.  
2. Press [Y] to process the initialization. To cancel  
initializing, press [N].  
2. As the message “Station Number?” will be displayed on the  
screen, input the station number of the unit to be copied.  
Select the table name to be copied, from A, P, B and  
D, using the alphabet keys.  
n
The table data will be lost note when performing the menu  
item [K].  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the table data will be copied,  
and the screen will return to the setting screen.  
4. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed again, the screen will  
return to the menu screen of the secondary station.  
When [Ctrl] _ [D] is pressed, the screen will return to  
the menu screen of the primary station.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3202 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 6  
A:Copy All table  
P:Copy PHANTOM table  
B:Copy PANEL table  
D:Copy Available Destination table  
Inputs A,P,B,D,0-9 Selected = A  
Station Number ?  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Example of Setting Screen  
Selected = A All the table data are copied.  
Selected = P Data set at the menu item [H : SET PHAN-  
TOM TABLE] are copied.  
Selected = B Data set at the menu item [N : SET PANEL  
TABLE] are copied.  
Selected = D Data set at the menu item [O : SET AVAIL-  
ABLE DESTINATION] are copied.  
n
The copy function of BKS-R* * * * guarantees upper  
compatibility only.  
The remote control unit except for BKS-R1607/R1608/  
R3209/R3210 may lost a part of the data, when coping the  
data from Ver. 3.* * unit to Ver. 1.* * unit, a part of the  
data may be lost (global phantom, etc.).  
The function is effective when copying the data from Ver.  
1.* * unit to Ver. 3.* * unit in a system.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
M: SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
(Except for HDS-V3232)  
N: SET PANEL TABLE (BKS-R1601/R3202/R3203)  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is used to set the monitor S-BUS. As this  
monitor function is controlled by the local CPU, it has a  
monitor data link that is independent from the standard S-  
BUS data link.  
This menu is used to assign source name to each source  
selection button.  
Setting Procedure  
Therefore, it is necessary to set the primary station and  
secondary stations for the monitor S-BUS.  
1. Select menu item [N].  
2. Select a button number using the cursor.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the source name can be  
typed. If [Enter] is pressed before inputting the  
source name, the registration will be deleted.  
4. Select the code assigned to each type name, and use  
the numerical keys to enter the source name.  
5. Press [Enter] to set the source name.  
6. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
Setting Procedure  
(For the Primary Station on the Monitor S-BUS)  
1. Select menu item [M].  
2. The menu screen of the primary station on the monitor  
S-BUS will be displayed.  
For details of setting this menu, refer to “5-3. Setting Items  
of the Primary Station on Monitor S-BUS”.  
Press [Ctrl] _ [D] to return to the menu screen of the  
primary station.  
SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
DVS-V6464B Monitor Bus I/F V2.10  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL TABLE( SOURCE )  
BKS-R1601 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 11  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
01 KEY=IN001  
05 KEY=IN005  
09 KEY=SONY009  
13 KEY=SONY013  
02 KEY=IN002  
06 KEY=IN006  
10 KEY=SONY010  
14 KEY=SONY014  
03 KEY=IN003  
07 KEY=SONY007  
11 KEY=IN011  
15 KEY=SONY015  
04 KEY=IN004  
08 KEY=SONY008  
12 KEY=IN012  
16 KEY=IN016  
F: SET SCTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
M: SELECT MONITOR FUNCTION (COMBINED)  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
0=SONY  
8=SL  
1=VTR  
9=L  
2=SUP  
A=RET  
3=CB  
4=AIR  
5=ME  
6=PGM  
E=L/A  
7=CL  
B=MIX  
C=JEEP  
D=OSC  
F=REN  
Example of Setting Screen  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
N: SET PANEL TABLE (BKS-R1607/R1608/R3204/R3205/R3209/R3210/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621)  
Purpose  
STATION NUMBER 3  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3219 V1.00  
CONTROL DESTINATION = OUT001  
SET PANEL TABLE(SOURCE)  
This menu is used to assign source/destination name to  
each source/destination button.  
01 KEY=IN001  
05 KEY=IN005  
02 KEY=IN002  
06 KEY=IN006  
03 KEY=IN003  
07 KEY=IN007  
04 KEY=IN004  
08 KEY=IN008  
09 KEY=....... 10 KEY=....... 11 KEY=....... 12 KEY=.......  
13 KEY=....... 14 KEY=....... 15 KEY=....... 16 KEY=.......  
17 KEY=IN009  
21 KEY=IN013  
18 KEY=IN010  
22 KEY=IN014  
19 KEY=IN011  
23 KEY=IN015  
20 KEY=IN012  
24 KEY=IN016  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [N].  
25 KEY=....... 26 KEY=....... 27 KEY=....... 28 KEY=.......  
29 KEY=....... 30 KEY=....... 31 KEY=....... 32 KEY=.......  
2. Select a button number using the cursor.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the panel table can be typed.  
To delete the registration, press [Enter] before  
inputting the name.  
SET PANEL TABLE(DESTINATION)  
01 KEY=....... 02 KEY=....... 03 KEY=....... 04 KEY=.......  
05 KEY=....... 06 KEY=....... 07 KEY=....... 08 KEY=.......  
09 KEY=OUT001  
13 KEY=OUT005  
10 KEY=OUT002  
14 KEY=OUT006  
11 KEY=OUT003  
15 KEY=OUT007  
12 KEY=OUT004  
16 KEY=OUT008  
17 KEY=....... 18 KEY=....... 19 KEY=....... 20 KEY=.......  
21 KEY=....... 22 KEY=....... 23 KEY=....... 24 KEY=.......  
4. a) When [J : NAME STYLE (Type + Num)] is  
selected in the primary station menu, input the  
type name (between 0 and F) and the number for  
the source and destination name.  
25 KEY=OUT009  
29 KEY=OUT013  
26 KEY=OUT010  
30 KEY=OUT014  
27 KEY=OUT011  
31 KEY=OUT015  
28 KEY=OUT012  
32 KEY=OUT016  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
9=CL  
2=SONY  
A=SL  
3=VTR  
B=L  
4=SUP  
C=RET  
K=AUX  
S=HD  
5=CB  
6=AIR  
E=JEEP  
M=BS  
7=ME  
8=PGM  
G=L/A  
O=SAT  
D=MIX  
L=COV  
T=D1-  
F=OSC  
N=CS  
H=REM  
P=CG  
I=CAM  
Q=WETH  
J=STDO  
R=TEST  
b) Each time Ctrl N is pressed when [J : NAME  
STYLE (DESCRIP. NAME)] is selected in the  
primary station menu, the following input mode  
will be switched alternately.  
U=D2-  
V=SEG  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Ctrl-N:DESCRIP.NAME T:TAKE M:MONI V:VTR E:LEVEL  
Example of Setting Screen  
Description name input mode :  
m
When “Ctrl_ N : Type + Num” is displayed on the  
screen, it means that the name mode will be  
changed to “Type + Number” by pressing [Ctrl] _  
[N].  
1. In the BKS-R1617/R1621, each button (key) can be  
set to both source and destination. In case source and  
destination are set to the same button (key), the DEST  
button works as a destination button when the DEST  
button lights in amber and the DEST button works as a  
source button when the DEST button lights in green.  
In the 4 DESTINATION mode, both source and  
destination can be set to only buttons (keys) 01 to 04.  
Other than setting of source button (key), the destina-  
tions of block 1 to 4 can be set to destination buttons  
01 to 04.  
Input Description name from the first to seventh  
characters using the alphabet and numerical keys.  
“Type + Number” name input mode:  
Input in the same way as a).  
n
If the Description name has been set for the input/output  
number, the display of Description has priority to the  
display of “Type + Number” even if the “Type + Number”  
name is set.  
Be sure to set either source or destination on the  
respective buttons (keys) when setting other model.  
If both source and destination are set to the same  
button (key), it will cause malfunction.  
5. When [Enter] is pressed, the source name is set.  
6. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen of the  
secondary station will be displayed.  
2. Set the table data of BKS-R3204/R3205/R3206 by  
eight buttons previously in the menu item [Z : SET  
____ PANEL STATUS]. If “KEY = ____” is  
displayed on the key number position, the name can  
not be input.  
When [Ctrl] _ [D] is pressed, the menu screen of the  
primary station will be displayed.  
3. When setting description names to the source/destina-  
tion buttons, select a name from the description name  
group sent to the remote control unit.  
If other names are input, these will not be set even if  
the [Enter] button is pressed.  
In such cases, transfer the group including the desired  
description name from the primary station.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
N: SET PANEL TABLE (BKS-R3206/R3216)  
4. When “T : TAKE M : MONI” is displayed on the  
screen, it means that the button on the source side can  
be set as the TAKE button or MONI button.  
Before pressing [Enter], select a key from the source  
side. To set it as the TAKE button, press [T]; to set it  
as the MONITOR button, press [M].  
5. When “V : VTR” is displayed on the screen, it means  
that the VTR control function can be assigned to the  
buttons on the source side.  
Purpose  
This menu is used to assign source name and destination  
name to be displayed.  
Setting Procedure  
The setting procedure is the same as that of menu item [N :  
SET PANEL TABLE] (BKS-R3204).  
m
Before pressing [Enter], select a key from the source  
side and press [V].  
Enter the number according to the list of operations on  
1. The setting of [SET PANEL TABLE (SOURCE)]  
assigns the source name and [SELECT DESTINA-  
TION] assigns the destination name.  
the bottom of the screen.  
2. The destination name can also be assigned using the  
button on the front panel. Refer to the Operation  
Manual for setting.  
3. If “Type + number” name mode is selected in the  
menu item [Z : SET PANEL STATUS], (refer to the  
Operation Manual of BKS-R3206) “SET PANEL  
TABLE (SOURCE)” is not displayed.  
6. When “E : LEVEL” is displayed on the screen, it  
means that the level control function can be assigned  
to the buttons on the source side.  
Before pressing [Enter], select a key from the source  
side and press [E].  
Enter the number according to the list of levels on the  
bottom of the screen.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL TABLE( SOURCE )  
BKS-R3206 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 18  
01 KEY=IN001  
05 KEY=IN005  
09 KEY=SONY009  
13 KEY=SONY013  
02 KEY=IN002  
06 KEY=IN006  
10 KEY=SONY010  
14 KEY=SONY014  
03 KEY=IN003  
07 KEY=SONY007  
11 KEY=IN011  
15 KEY=SONY015  
04 KEY=IN004  
08 KEY=SONY008  
12 KEY=IN012  
16 KEY=IN016  
n
In BKS-R1607 of version V1.10 and higher, any desired  
button among the sixteen buttons can be set as a TAKE  
button.  
When this setting is performed, the name selected by the  
SELECTOR knob on the front panel can be taken by  
pressing the TAKE button.  
SELECT DESTINATION  
01  
05  
09  
13  
OUT001  
OUT005  
OUT009  
OUT013  
02  
06  
10  
14  
OUT002  
OUT006  
OUT010  
OUT014  
03  
07  
11  
15  
OUT003  
OUT007  
OUT011  
OUT015  
04  
08  
12  
16  
OUT004  
OUT008  
OUT012  
OUT016  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
9=CL  
2=SONY  
A=SL  
3=VTR  
B=L  
4=SUP  
C=RET  
K=AUX  
S=HD  
5=CB  
6=AIR  
E=JEEP  
M=BS  
7=ME  
(Maximum inputs 512 x outputs 512)  
8=PGM  
G=L/A  
O=SAT  
D=MIX  
L=COV  
T=D1-  
F=OSC  
N=CS  
H=REM  
P=CG  
I=CAM  
Q=WETH  
J=STDO  
R=TEST  
U=D2-  
V=SEG  
The actual setting procedure is as follows. Select a key  
from the source side which you want to use as the TAKE  
button. Press the [T] button.  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Ctrl-N:DESCRIP.NAME  
Example of Setting Screen  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R1607 V1.10 STATION NUMBER 12  
SET PANEL TABLE(SOURCE) CONTROL DESTINATION = OUT244  
01 KEY=SRC004  
05 KEY=SRC002  
09 KEY=SRC009  
13 KEY=.......  
02 KEY=SRC005  
03 KEY=SRC006  
07 KEY=SRC007  
11 KEY=SRC013  
15 KEY=.......  
04 KEY=SRC001  
06 KEY=SRC003  
10 KEY=SRC010  
14 KEY=.......  
08 KEY=SRC008  
12 KEY=SRC014  
16 KEY=TAKE  
SET PANEL TABLE(DESTINATION)  
01 KEY=.......  
05 KEY=.......  
09 KEY=.......  
13 KEY=OUT001  
02 KEY=.......  
06 KEY=.......  
10 KEY=.......  
14 KEY=OUT012  
03 KEY=.......  
07 KEY=.......  
11 KEY=.......  
15 KEY=OUT003  
04 KEY=.......  
08 KEY=.......  
12 KEY=.......  
16 KEY=.......  
0=SRC  
8=8  
1=OUT  
9=9  
2=2  
A=A  
3=3  
B=B  
4=4  
C=C  
5=5  
D=D  
6=6  
E=E  
7=7  
F=F  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Ctrl-N:DESCRIP.NAME T:TAKE  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
O: SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION  
(BKS-R3202/R3206)  
O: SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION  
(BKS-R1607/R3210/R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/  
R3220/R1621)  
Purpose  
This menu is used to set the destination which can be  
selected by the remote control unit.  
Purpose  
This menu sets the range of selectable destinations and the  
range of selectable sources corresponding to the range of  
selectable destinations.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Call the menu screen of the remote control unit to be  
set using menu item [R], and then select menu item  
[O].  
2. Select the destination using the cursor.  
Press [(] and [)] when the cursor is placed at the top  
or bottom, and the next destination number will  
appear. The destination numbers are 001 to 512.  
3. When press [Enter], the status of the destination  
indicated by cursor will be changed.  
Setting procedure  
1. Invoke the menu display of the remote control unit to set  
the menu item [R]. Then select the menu item [O].  
2. Select a destination to be set using the cursor key.  
When the key [(], [)] is pressed while the cursor key  
is located either top end or bottom end of display, the  
display moves to that of the next terminal number.  
The output terminal numbers are from 001 to 512.  
3. Pressing [Enter] toggles between selection and non-  
selection of destination shown by cursor.  
m
m
. The destination name indicated on this screen can be  
selected from the remote control unit.  
. The destination indicated as “ · · · · ” is not registered  
on the destination table.  
. The blank destination can not be selected from the  
remote control unit.  
. The destinations whose names are displayed, can be  
selected from this remote control.  
. The indication “ · · · · ” means that the name is not  
registered yet on the destination table.  
. The blank destination cannot be selected from the  
panel.  
4. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to display the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SELECT DESTINATION NAME  
BKS-R3216 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 4  
0001=OUT001  
0005=OUT005  
0009=OUT009  
0013=OUT013  
0017=OUT017  
0021=OUT021  
0025=OUT025  
0029=OUT029  
0033=OUT033  
0037=OUT037  
0041=OUT041  
0045=OUT045  
0049=OUT049  
0053=OUT053  
0057=OUT057  
0061=OUT061  
0002=OUT002  
0006=OUT006  
0010=OUT010  
0014=OUT014  
0018=OUT018  
0022=OUT022  
0026=OUT026  
0030=OUT030  
0034=OUT034  
0038=OUT038  
0042=OUT042  
0046=OUT046  
0050=OUT050  
0054=OUT054  
0058=OUT058  
0062=OUT062  
0003=OUT003  
0007=OUT007  
0011=OUT011  
0015=OUT015  
0019=OUT019  
0023=OUT023  
0027=OUT027  
0031=OUT031  
0035=OUT035  
0039=OUT039  
0043=OUT043  
0047=OUT047  
0051=OUT051  
0055=OUT055  
0059=OUT059  
0063=OUT063  
0004=OUT004  
0008=OUT008  
0012=OUT012  
0016=OUT016  
0020=OUT020  
0024=OUT024  
0028=OUT028  
0032=OUT032  
0036=OUT036  
0040=OUT040  
0044=OUT044  
0048=OUT048  
0052=OUT052  
0056=OUT056  
0060=OUT060  
0064=OUT064  
Press [Ctrl] _ [D] to display the menu screen of the  
primary station.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SELECT DESTINATION NAME  
BKS-R3202 V3.10  
STATION NUMBER 7  
001=OUT001  
005=OUT005  
009=OUT009  
013=OUT013  
017=OUT017  
021=OUT021  
025=OUT025  
029=OUT029  
033=OUT033  
037=OUT037  
041=OUT041  
045=OUT045  
049=  
002=OUT002  
006=OUT006  
010=OUT010  
014=OUT014  
018=OUT018  
022=OUT022  
026=OUT026  
030=OUT030  
034=OUT034  
038=OUT038  
042=OUT042  
046=OUT046  
050=OUT050  
054=OUT054  
058=  
003=OUT003  
007=OUT007  
011=OUT011  
015=OUT015  
019=OUT019  
023=OUT023  
027=OUT027  
031=OUT031  
035=OUT035  
039=OUT039  
043=OUT043  
047=OUT047  
051=OUT051  
055=OUT055  
059=  
004=OUT004  
008=OUT008  
012=OUT012  
016=OUT016  
020=OUT020  
024=OUT024  
028=OUT028  
032=OUT032  
036=OUT036  
040=OUT040  
044=OUT044  
048=  
052=OUT052  
056=OUT056  
060=  
053=OUT053  
057=  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Ctrl-F:SELECT SOURCE  
061=OUT061  
062=OUT062  
063=OUT063  
064=OUT064  
Example of Setting Screen (Selectable Destination)  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
4. Press [Ctrl] _ [F] to switch to the display allowing  
Example of Setting Screen  
setting of the selectable sources.  
Pressing [Ctrl] _ [E] switches to the menu screen of  
the secondary station.  
Pressing [Ctrl] _ [D] returns to the menu screen of the  
primary station.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
. Procedure of setting SELECT SOURCE NAME  
(Input)  
1024  
164  
101  
64  
1
1. Select an item to set using the cursor key.  
2. Pressing [Enter] establishes the source name input  
mode.  
Block 2  
Block 1  
3. Enter the “Type + No.” name or description name.  
4. Press [Enter] to confirm the input contents.  
64  
Example of setting  
101  
Block  
Source  
Destination  
(Used area) (Input range)  
(Output range)  
Block 3  
TOP  
END  
TOP  
END  
1
2
3
1
64  
1
64  
164  
101  
101  
164  
164  
1
64  
101  
164  
1024  
(Output)  
Virtual matrix  
When the ranges of input and output selections are limited  
as shown in the above table, the setting display and the  
virtual matrix are configured as shown below.  
: Used areas  
: Un-used areas  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SELECT SOURCE NAME  
BKS-R3216 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 4  
m
SRC TOP -SRC END =DST TOP -DST END  
001 IN001  
002 IN101  
003 IN101  
-IN064  
-IN164  
-IN164  
=OUT001 -OUT064  
=OUT001 -OUT064  
=OUT101 -OUT164  
1. When selecting the destinations that have no limit of  
range, the selectable range of sources is from 001 to  
1024.  
2. BKS-R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621  
makes all the sources within the range that includes the  
selected destinations valid. OUT001 makes the  
multiple ranges of IN001 to IN064 and IN101 to  
IN164 valid when the selection is made as shown in  
“Example of Setting Screen”.  
004 ....... -....... =....... -.......  
005 ....... -....... =....... -.......  
006 ....... -....... =....... -.......  
007 ....... -....... =....... -.......  
008 ....... -....... =....... -.......  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
9=CL  
2=SONY  
A=SL  
3=VTR  
B=L  
4=SUP  
C=RET  
K=AUX  
S=HD  
5=CB  
6=AIR  
E=JEEP  
M=BS  
7=ME  
8=PGM  
G=L/A  
O=SAT  
D=MIX  
L=COV  
T=D1-  
F=OSC  
N=CS  
In BKS-R1607/R3210 of version V1.10 and higher, a pair  
of source signal and key signal can be output as an inter-  
locked pair using the offset-type phantom. (See OUT1 to  
H=REM  
P=CG  
I=CAM  
Q=WETH  
J=STDO  
R=TEST  
U=D2-  
V=SEG  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Ctrl-N:Type + Num Ctrl-F:SELECT DESTINATION  
OUT4 in the following illustration.)  
Odd number : Source  
Example of Setting Screen  
(Setting the range of selectable sources)  
Even number : Key  
(Input) 9  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
n
1
In BKS-R1607/R3210 of version V1.10 and higher, the sig-  
nal switching cannot be performed when the destination  
range that is set by SELECT SOURCE NAME is exceeded  
even when the destination-type offset phantom has already  
been set using the menu item [H]. Setting must be per-  
formed so that the resultant value of destination after addi-  
tion and subtraction of offset stays within the eight blocks of  
SELECT SOURCE NAME. When the offset value is zero  
(DST+0), the signal switching can be operated.  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
(Output)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
Example of setting :  
SRC TOP-SRC END=DST TOP-DST END indicates the  
applicable range of the offset-type phantom on the screen  
of example setting. When the range from IN001 to IN008,  
and the range from OUT001 to OUT004 are to be set as  
the applicable range, enter as follows.  
IN001-IN008=OUT001-OUT004  
When you want execute the combinations of  
OUT001<IN001 and OUT002<IN002, or the combinations  
of OUT003<IN001 and OUT004<IN002, enter as follows.  
Phantom:  
IN001: DST+0<IN001-10000000  
IN001: DST+1<IN002-10000000  
Here, 10000000 means the level-1. The level-2 corre-  
sponds to 0100000.  
When the above settings are performed and the buttons  
OUT001 and IN001 are pressed in this order, OUT001 is  
replaced by OUT002 with DST+1.  
Then,  
OUT001<IN001  
OUT002<IN002  
of the level-1 are switched.  
When the buttons OUT003 and IN001 are pressed in this  
order,  
OUT003<IN001  
OUT004<IN001  
of the level-1 are switched.  
When OUT005 and IN001 are pressed, DST+0<IN001-  
10000000 (i.e., OUT005<IN001) only are switched since it  
is outside the applicable range.  
Set the phantom for IN003, IN005 and IN007 in the same  
way.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
R: SET ROUTE (BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210/R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621)  
Purpose  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3216 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 4  
SET ROUTE(ROUTE DESTINATION:DESTINATION<SOURCE-LEVEL)  
This is the function to display the source names that are  
expanded by combining the two switchers for the purpose  
of expanding numbers of input.  
ROUTE  
| DEST  
| SOURCE | LEVEL1-8 | ROUTE  
| DEST  
| SOURCE | LEVEL1-8  
- 10000000  
OUT001 : OUT017 < IN005  
- 10000000 | OUT002 : OUT018 < IN006  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000 | ....... : ....... < ....... - 00000000  
When a route is set, the source that is connected to the  
route destination, is automatically chased out the and the  
name of the source is displayed. In an example shown  
below, IN001 of the switcher A is displayed as the source  
name when OUT017 of the switcher B is selected.  
It has another function as follows. When a request of  
switching including the expanded destination, is issued,  
crosspoint of the route destination side is automatically  
switched. For example, when IN001-OUT001 of the  
switcher A is switched, IN005-OUT017 of the switcher B  
is also switched at the same time.  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
9=CL  
2=SONY  
A=SL  
3=VTR  
B=L  
4=SUP  
C=RET  
K=AUX  
S=HD  
5=CB  
6=AIR  
E=JEEP  
M=BS  
7=ME  
8=PGM  
G=L/A  
O=SAT  
D=MIX  
L=COV  
T=D1-  
F=OSC  
N=CS  
H=REM  
P=CG  
I=CAM  
Q=WETH  
J=STDO  
R=TEST  
U=D2-  
V=SEG  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Ctrl-N:DESCRIP.NAME +:DST+  
Example of Setting Screen  
In the setting screen example as shown above, the cross-  
point of IN005-OUT017 is switched at the same time when  
a crosspoints including OUT001 (ex. IN002-OUT001) is  
switched. Then, source (IN002) of the switcher-A’s  
OUT001 is displayed (IN002-OUT017) for OUT017 of the  
switcher-B. The above described operation is executed by  
selecting OUT001 and IN002 from the remote control unit.  
However, it is recommended to set the phantom of IN002:  
OUT001 < IN002 beforehand on the remote control panel,  
because the operation of selecting IN002-OUT001 instead  
of OUT017 looks unnatural when IN002-OUT017 is going  
to be taken.  
1 2  
3
4
IN  
OUT1  
OUT2  
OUT3  
Expansion input  
IN 5 6  
7
8
OUT17  
OUT18  
OUT19  
Level1  
Switcher A  
Level1  
Switcher B  
Route Function  
To add the offset amount to the selected destination, enter  
[+] in the DEST column before pressing [Enter].  
After “DEST +” is displayed, enter the offset value (0 to  
1023) and press [Enter] to store the value.  
Setting procedure  
1. Select the menu item [R] of the secondary station.  
2. Select the desired item using the cursor key.  
3. Pressing [Enter] establishes the route setting mode.  
When [Enter] is pressed again before entering data,  
registration is canceled.  
Each level can be set by selecting ON (1) or OFF (0).  
4. Enter the “Type + No.” name or description name.  
(The setting methods remains the same as that of  
phantom. Refer to the description of the secondary  
station’s menu item [H : SET PHANTOM TABLE].  
However, the destination name of the switcher-A to  
which source of the switcher-B is connected, should be  
input on this menu, instead of the phantom name.)  
5. Press [Enter] to confirm the input contents.  
6. Pressing [Ctrl] _ [E] switches to the menu screen of  
the secondary station.  
Pressing [Ctrl] _ [D] returns to the menu screen of the  
primary station.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
S : DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Purpose  
n
This menu is used to check the group and names of the  
Description transferred from the primary station.  
In BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210 of version V1.10 and  
higher, the 160 description names that are transferred from  
the primary station can be registered in the range of inputs  
512 x outputs 512 in the order of terminal number regard-  
less of the block number. When you want to use more than  
160 of the description names, transmit the names from the  
primary station after dividing the description names into  
several blocks.  
Check Procedure  
1. When [Enter] or [SPACE] is pressed, the screen will  
be changed to the next page.  
2. When [BS] or [DEL] is pressed, the screen will be  
changed to the previous page.  
3. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to display the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
The following operations are possible from the screen.  
Look at destination from source side : [*] key  
Look at source from destination side : [&] key  
Press [Ctrl] _ [D] to display the menu screen of the  
primary station.  
Return to the previous page :  
Move to the next page :  
[(] key  
[)] key  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
GROUP No. = 1  
BKS-R3206 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 16  
No. Terminal Name  
Description Name  
No. Terminal Name  
Description Name  
1 DST- 001 OUT001 London  
2 DST- 002 OUT002 NewYork  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SOURCE  
BKS-R3210 V1.10  
STATION NUMBER 6  
3 SRC- 001 IN001  
5 SRC- 003 IN003  
7 SRC- 005 IN005  
9 SRC- 007 IN007  
Berlin  
Tokyo  
4 SRC- 002 IN002  
6 SRC- 004 IN004  
8 SRC- 006 IN006  
Moscow  
Cairo  
name  
1 IN001  
3 IN003  
5 IN005  
7 IN007  
9 IN009  
11 IN011  
13 IN013  
15 IN015  
17 IN017  
19 IN019  
21 IN021  
23 IN023  
25 IN025  
27 IN027  
29 IN029  
31 IN031  
Description  
CAM001  
CAM003  
VTR005  
VTR007  
ONAIR01  
ONAIR03  
STADIO1  
STADIO3  
MONI001  
IN019  
name  
2 IN002  
4 IN004  
6 IN006  
8 IN008  
10 IN010  
12 IN012  
14 IN014  
16 IN016  
18 IN018  
20 IN020  
22 IN022  
24 IN024  
26 IN026  
28 IN028  
30 IN030  
32 IN032  
Description  
Berjing  
Tpronto  
Madrid  
CAM002  
CAM004  
VTR006  
VTR008  
ONAIR02  
ONAIR04  
STADIO2  
STADIO4  
MONI002  
IN020  
10 DST- 005 OUT005 Paris  
12 DST- 012 VTR012 OUT012  
14 DST- 014 VTR014 OUT014  
16 DST- 016 SONY016 OUT016  
18 DST- 018 VTR018 OUT018  
20 DST- 020 VTR020 OUT020  
22 DST- 022 VTR022 OUT022  
24 DST- 024 VTR024 OUT024  
26 DST- 026 VTR026 OUT026  
28 DST- 028 VTR028 OUT028  
30 DST- 030 VTR030 OUT030  
32 DST- 032 VTR032 OUT032  
34 DST- 034 VTR034 OUT034  
36 DST- 036 VTR036 OUT036  
38 DST- 038 VTR038 OUT038  
40 DST- 040 VTR040 OUT040  
11 DST- 008 OUT008 Rome  
13 DST- 013 VTR013 OUT013  
15 DST- 015 VTR015 OUT015  
17 DST- 017 VTR017 OUT017  
19 DST- 019 VTR019 OUT019  
21 DST- 021 VTR021 OUT021  
23 DST- 023 VTR023 OUT023  
25 DST- 025 VTR025 OUT025  
27 DST- 027 VTR027 OUT027  
29 DST- 029 VTR029 OUT029  
31 DST- 031 VTR031 OUT031  
33 DST- 033 VTR033 OUT033  
35 DST- 035 VTR035 OUT035  
37 DST- 037 VTR037 OUT037  
39 DST- 039 VTR039 OUT039  
IN021  
IN022  
IN023  
IN024  
IN025  
IN026  
IN027  
IN028  
IN029  
IN030  
IN031  
IN032  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Right:DESTINATION Left:SOURCE  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Ctrl-H:Pg-Up  
Ctrl-M:Pg-Dn  
Example of Setting Screen  
Example of Setting Screen  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
DESTINATION  
BKS-R3210 V1.10  
STATION NUMBER 6  
name  
Description  
name  
Description  
1 OUT001 DST001  
3 OUT003 DST003  
5 OUT005 DST005  
7 OUT007 DST007  
9 OUT009 OUT009  
11 OUT011 OUT011  
13 OUT013 OUT013  
15 OUT015 OUT015  
17 OUT017 OUT017  
19 OUT019 OUT019  
21 OUT021 OUT021  
23 OUT023 OUT023  
25 OUT025 OUT025  
27 OUT027 OUT027  
29 OUT029 OUT029  
31 OUT031 OUT031  
2 OUT002 DST002  
4 OUT004 DST004  
6 OUT006 DST006  
8 OUT008 DST008  
10 OUT010 OUT010  
12 OUT012 OUT012  
14 OUT014 OUT014  
16 OUT016 OUT016  
18 OUT018 OUT018  
20 OUT020 OUT020  
22 OUT022 OUT022  
24 OUT024 OUT024  
26 OUT026 OUT026  
28 OUT028 OUT028  
30 OUT030 OUT030  
32 OUT032 OUT032  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Right:DESTINATION Left:SOURCE  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
U: SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL  
Purpose  
n
This menu is used to set channels A and B of REMOTE 2  
(D-sub 9-pin) to loop-through. When the REMOTE 2  
control mode is set to DIRECT, this menu is used to set the  
protocol and the conversion table of the input/output  
numbers.  
The same number cannot be set to more than one place. If  
the same number is used, the message “* * * is used  
already; Ignored” will be displayed and the cursor will stop  
at its current position.  
There are three kinds of protocols.  
. PRODUCTION SWITCHER PROTOCOL  
. AUDIO MIXER PROTOCOL  
SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL  
CHANNEL = A  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
UA2 = 10000000  
REMOTE = CART+  
. CART PROTOCOL  
SET DESTINATION TRANSCODE( CN NUM.= REMOTE NUM.)  
1=001  
9=009  
2=002  
3=003  
4=004  
5=005  
6=006  
7=007  
8=008  
10=010  
18=018  
26=026  
34=034  
42=042  
50=050  
58=058  
11=011  
19=019  
27=027  
35=035  
43=043  
51=051  
59=059  
12=012  
20=020  
28=028  
36=036  
44=044  
52=052  
60=060  
13=013  
21=021  
29=029  
37=037  
45=045  
53=053  
61=061  
14=014  
22=022  
30=030  
38=038  
46=046  
54=054  
62=062  
15=015  
23=023  
31=031  
39=039  
47=047  
55=055  
63=063  
16=016  
24=024  
32=032  
40=040  
48=048  
56=056  
64=064  
n
17=017  
25=025  
33=033  
41=041  
49=049  
57=057  
AUDIO MIXER PROTOCOL was known as “SWITCH-  
ER PROTOCOL” before.  
SET SOURCE TRANSCODE( CN NUM.= REMOTE NUM.)  
Set the conversion table of the input/output numbers so  
that the input/output numbers defined by the external  
controller will correspond to those of the routing switcher.  
In the THROUGH mode, there will be no setting menu for  
channel B. For details of the DIRECT mode, refer to the  
menu item [U : SELECT CONTROL MODE] in the  
primary station.  
1=001  
9=009  
2=002  
3=003  
4=004  
5=005  
6=006  
7=007  
8=008  
10=010  
18=018  
26=026  
34=034  
42=042  
50=050  
58=058  
11=011  
19=019  
27=027  
35=035  
43=043  
51=051  
59=059  
12=012  
20=020  
28=028  
36=036  
44=044  
52=052  
60=060  
13=013  
21=021  
29=029  
37=037  
45=045  
53=053  
61=061  
14=014  
22=022  
30=030  
38=038  
46=046  
54=054  
62=062  
15=015  
23=023  
31=031  
39=039  
47=047  
55=055  
63=063  
16=016  
24=024  
32=032  
40=040  
48=048  
56=056  
64=064  
17=017  
25=025  
33=033  
41=041  
49=049  
57=057  
CAS=065  
F1:REMOTE F2:DEFAULT F3:DEST. F4:SOURCE  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [U].  
Example of Setting Screen  
2. “SELECT RS-422 CHANNEL =? (A B) A” will be  
displayed. Input A or B using the alphabet keys and  
press [Enter]. The screen will change to the setting  
screen of the selected channel.  
Operating Function Keys  
[F1] : REMOTE (To switch the protocol)  
1. When [F1] is pressed, the cursor will move to  
“REMOTE”.  
2. When [Enter] is pressed, the protocol will be  
switched. To change the “* * *” of “UA2 =”,  
select the desired position with the cursor and  
press [Enter] to switch 1/0 alternately.  
SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
SELECT RS-422 CHANNEL ? (A--B) A  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
3. The cursor will be placed at “1=001” of “SET DESTI-  
NATION TRANSCODE”.  
n
The description “* * *” of “UA2 =* * *” on the above  
menu corresponds to the DIP switch setting which LSB is  
at the left end.  
When [Enter] is pressed, “1=” will be displayed and  
the number can be typed. The left “1” in “1=001”  
indicates the input/output number of the switcher and  
the right “001” indicates the command number  
received.  
[F2] : DEFAULT (Initializing the data)  
1. When [F2] is pressed, “DEFAULT ok? (y/n)”  
will be displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
2. When [Y] is pressed, the program will be  
executed. When [N] is pressed, it will not be  
executed.  
4. Input a number between 1 and 128 and press [Enter]  
set it. The cursor will move to the next number.  
If “00” is input, “001” will be displayed. If number  
129 or later is input, the previous number will be  
displayed. If [Enter] is pressed without inputting  
anything, invalid crosspoints will be set so that the  
screen will show “ · · · · ”, and the cursor will move to  
the next number. When [Ctrl] _ [F] is pressed before  
the setting, the previous number will be displayed and  
the cursor will move to the next number.  
[F3] : DEST  
When [F3] is pressed, the cursor will move to the  
destination side.  
[F4] : SOURCE  
When [F4] is pressed, the cursor will move to the  
source side.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
V : DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
(Except for HDS-V3232)  
Y : DISPLAY TABLE DATA  
(Except for HDS-V3232)  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is used to display the status of the hardware  
such as boards, etc.  
This menu is used to display the table data set with the  
control terminal.  
n
For the input/output boards and matrix boards of DVS-  
V3232B, channel 1 to 32 will be displayed. And FAN 1  
and 2 will be displayed for DVS-V3232B.  
Operation Procedure  
1. Select menu item [Y]. The following message will be  
displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
Display: “DISPLAY TABLE DATA? (y/n)”  
2. Press [Y], and the 4:2:2/4 fsc setting value will be  
displayed in hexadecimal. Press [A], and the table  
data will be displayed in hexadecimal.  
Operating Procedure  
1. Select menu item [V].  
2. Press [Ctrl] _ [E]. The menu screen will be dis-  
played.  
When [N] is pressed, the table data display will be  
cancelled.  
DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 2  
3. When [SPACE] is pressed during the display, the  
display will be interrupted. When [SPACE] is  
pressed once again, the display will begin.  
4. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to stop the display. The menu  
screen of the secondary station will be displayed.  
INPUT BOARD  
01-32  
INPUT CONNECTOR BOARD  
INPUT CASCADE CONNECTOR BOARD  
REV. 00  
REV. 00  
01-16  
17-32  
33-48  
49-64  
BNC  
BNC  
01-32  
33-64  
VALID  
VALID  
33-64  
BNC  
OUTPUT BOARD  
01-32  
INVALID  
OUTPUT CASCADE CONNECTOR BOARD  
INVALID  
01-32  
33-64  
VALID  
VALID  
33-64  
REV. 00 OUTPUT CONNECTOR BOARD  
01-08  
09-16  
17-24  
25-32  
33-40  
41-48  
BNC  
MATRIX BOARD  
CASCADE  
REFERENCE SIGNAL MISSING  
SELECT FIELD  
DISPLAY TABLE DATA  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 17  
01-32(OUT) REV. 00  
33-64(OUT) REV. 00  
CASCADE  
BNC  
0000:49 4E 00 00 00 00 00 00 4F 55 54 00 00 00 00 00 : IN......OUT.....  
0010:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0020:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0030:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0040:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0050:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0060:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0070:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
0080:56 49 44 00 00 00 00 00 41 31 00 00 00 00 00 00 : VID.....A1......  
0090:41 32 00 00 00 00 00 00 34 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : A2......4.......  
00A0:35 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 36 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : 5.......6.......  
00B0:37 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 38 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : 7.......8.......  
00C0:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
00D0:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 : ................  
00E0:00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 02 FF FF 10 00 00 02 : ................  
CASCADE  
CASCADE  
CASCADE  
INVALID  
CONTROL BOARD  
POWER SUPPLIES  
MAIN S-BUS RS422 49-56  
A
B
ON  
M V2.10 V2.02 V2.10 57-64  
INVALID  
B
INVALID  
FAN1 FAN2 FAN3 FAN4  
OPTION BOARD  
CONNECTOR BOARD  
VALID  
ROT  
ROT  
ROT  
ROT  
INVALID  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Display  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Display  
n
For the details of the table data, refer to the S-BUS Proto-  
col Manual.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
Y : SET DISPLAY MODES (BKS-R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621)  
Purpose  
Setting Procedure  
This menu is used to set the display mode.  
The setting contents are as follows.  
1. Select the menu item [Y].  
2. The cursor appears in “DISPLAY MODES = 1”.  
Move the cursor to an arbitrary mode and press  
[Enter] establishes the input mode.  
3. Enter the desired number with the numeric keys.  
Press [Enter] to set the number ; the cursor moves to  
the next setting item.  
DISPLAY MODES (BKS-R3216/R3220):  
Selects the display type. (when J : NAME STYLE  
(DESCRIP.NAME) is selected in the primary station  
menu.)  
NORMAL = Normal display  
2 + 2CHAR = Displays two letters before and after the  
name.  
If you do not want to change the default value, press  
[Enter] without entering any number.  
4. To set “TALLY GROUP”, move the cursor to the  
position of the desired tally (in the case of tally 2,  
second “_” from the left) and press [Enter]. The item  
is toggled on and off every time [Enter] is pressed.  
(When the number is displayed, the item is ON. When  
_” is displayed, the item is OFF.)  
4CHAR =  
Displays four letters from the beginning  
of the name.  
n
If 2 : 2 + 2CHAR or 3 : 4CHAR is selected when J :  
NAME STYLE (Type + Num) is selected in the primary  
station menu, the two letters and two numbers of the type  
name are displayed.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET DISPLAY MODES  
BKS-R3220 V1.03  
STATION NUMBER 2  
DISPLAY MODES  
PANEL FUNCTION  
TALLY GROUP  
= 1  
1:NORMAL 2:2+2CHAR  
3:4CHAR *:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
= *  
1:NORMAL 2:4 DESTINATION  
= 1---  
PANEL FUNCTION (BKS-R1617/R1618/R3219/R1621):  
Sets the operation mode of the panel.  
NORMAL =  
Normal selection mode  
4 DESTINATION = Destinations can be set for each  
block of the source button that  
consists of four blocks.  
Set each source button and also set  
the destination of each block using  
the menu item [N : SET PANEL  
TABLE].  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN  
TALLY GROUP  
Example of Setting Screen  
Selects the tally group.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
Z : SELECT SDI FORMAT  
(Except for HDS-V3232)  
Purpose  
Operating Function Keys  
This menu is used to set the format of signals fed to the  
input/output board of DVS-V3232B and DVS-V6464B  
with the control terminal.  
This setting is available when the manual switch for the  
format on each input/output board is OFF.  
[F1] : FORMAT (Mode which sets the signal format by 8-  
channels)  
[F2] : FIELD (Mode which sets the crosspoint switching  
field)  
1. Press [F2]. The cursor will move to “SWITCH  
ING FIELD” in the menu.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [Z].  
2. Press [Enter]. The setting will change.  
(ODD EVEN FIELD ASYNC ODD)  
All switching field in the switcher are deter  
mined by this setting.  
2. Select a channel line using the cursor to be set. (The  
channels will be switched by eight channels.  
Displayed signal formats that are enclosed by the  
round brackets as “(4:2:2)” have been set on the board  
and cannot be modified with the control terminal.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the setting will change  
(“4:2:2” “4 fsc NTSC” “4 fsc PAL”).  
4. Press [S] (Table Set), and the content now appeared is  
copied to the area of SDI FORMAT TABLE.  
5. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to stop the display and the menu  
screen of the secondary station will be displayed.  
n
To use RS-422A and S-BUS together, set the switching  
field as follows.  
1 When using the S-BUS and CART protocol together :  
ODD  
2 When using the S-BUS and PRODUCTION  
SWITCHER protocol together : FIELD  
Note that the switching timing of the CART will not be  
accurate if the CART and PRODUCTION SWITCHERS  
protocols are used together.  
SELECT SDI FORMAT  
DESTINATION UNIT  
DVS-V6464B V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE UNIT  
Switching timing is not guaranteed in the combination of  
different switching fields.  
For details of the signal switching timing, refer to “5-8.  
Signal Switching Timing”.  
01 - 08 : 4:2:2  
09 - 16 : 4fsc NTSC  
17 - 24 : 4fsc PAL  
25 - 32 : 4:2:2  
33 - 40 : 4:2:2  
41 - 48 : 4:2:2  
49 - 56 :( 4:2:2 )  
57 - 64 : 4:2:2  
01 - 08 : 4:2:2  
09 - 16 : 4:2:2  
17 - 24 : 4:2:2  
25 - 32 : 4:2:2  
33 - 40 : 4:2:2  
41 - 48 : 4:2:2  
49 - 56 :( 4:2:2 )  
57 - 64 : 4:2:2  
SWITCHING FIELD  
FIELD  
F1:FORMAT F2:FIELD S:Table Set Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
n
Unless pressing [S], the data will be deleted when the  
power is turned off.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS (BKS-R3204/R3205/R3206)  
Purpose  
5. When “PANEL MODE=3” (the DAUGHTER) is  
selected on BKS-R3204, the MOTHER ID number is  
displayed as “MOTHER STATION ID= xx”. The  
MOTHER ID number is set using the switch on the  
rear panel. If switch setting is 0, 1, 255, “Incorrect ID  
(0, 1, 255) is designated.” is displayed, while “The  
designated ID is not found” is displayed if the mother  
station ID is not registered in the block.  
6. In setting of BKS-R3206 different from BKS-R3204/  
R3205, there is no “SELECT SOURCE OR DESTI-  
NATION ASSIGNMENT”, Use either “Type name +  
Number” or “the source direct” to designate the source  
name.  
Besides the remote control unit can be used alone, several  
units can be used together as if it were one unit with  
expanded sources and destinations. When using several  
units together, one will serve as the mother and the rest  
will serve as the daughters.  
This menu is used to perform the settings necessary in such  
cases. The selection of stand alone use, mother use, and  
daughter use is performed in this menu in addition to the  
assignment of buttons on the front panel. If assigned as the  
mother station, a block number should be set. (up to 10  
mothers can be registered.)  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [Z].  
“PANEL LAYOUT= x” is displayed. Press [Enter]  
and input the numbers.  
2. Place the cursor on “PANEL MODE=1” and press  
[Enter] to select an item. Selection should be per-  
formed using the following keys.  
7. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to display to the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
Press [Ctrl] _ [D] to display to the menu screen of the  
primary station.  
BKS-R3204 : 1. STAND ALONE  
3. DAUGHTER  
2. MOTHER  
BKS-R3205 : 1. STAND ALONE  
BKS-R3206 : 1. STAND ALONE  
If selection is not necessary, press [Enter] again.  
3. Place the cursor on “KEY 1-8=S” and press [Enter] to  
set S or D. The button number is set in order from top  
left to right, then left bottom to right as shown below.  
2. MOTHER  
2. MOTHER  
n
When “PANEL MODE=1” (the STAND ALONE) is  
selected on BKS-R3204 and BKS-R3205, all KEYs (1 to  
32) can not be assigned as DESTINATION. If all is set as  
DESTINATION, the KEYs 1 to 8 are set to “KEYs 1 to  
8=S” automatically.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL STATUS  
BKS-R3204 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 14  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16  
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32  
PANEL MODE = 1  
1:STAND ALONE  
2:MOTHER  
3:DAUGHTER  
To change to the next setting, press [Enter].  
SET SOURCE OR DESTINATION ASSIGNMENT  
KEY 1- 8 = S  
KEY 9-16 = S  
KEY 25-32 = S  
KEY 17-24 = S  
4. When “PANEL MODE=2” (the MOTHER) is select-  
ed, move the cursor to “SET BLOCK NUMBER=X”  
and press [Enter] to enter block number. When  
[Enter] is pressed again, the block number will be set.  
If the mother station is set, the ID are displayed.  
S:SOURCE  
D:DESTINATION  
MOTHER STATION ID=12(BKS-R3206)  
MOTHER STATION BLOCK LIST  
BLOCK 1 = STATION 12 | BLOCK 6 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = STATION 5  
BLOCK 3 = STATION 2  
BLOCK 4 = STATION 3  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Example of Setting Screen (BKS-R3204)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS (BKS-R1607/R1608/  
R3209/R3210/R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/  
R3220/R1621)  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL STATUS  
BKS-R3205 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 11  
Purpose  
PANEL MODE = 1  
1:STAND ALONE  
2:MOTHER  
This is the function to set the various modes of the remote  
control unit. In the models corresponding this menu as  
shown above the multiple units can be connected in order  
to expand the number of sources and destinations which  
can be controlled simultaneously. Setting the mother panel  
and the daughter panels is performed from this menu.  
(Maximum ten mother panels can be set.)  
SET SOURCE OR DESTINATION ASSIGNMENT  
KEY 1- 8 = S  
KEY 17-24 = S  
S:SOURCE  
KEY 9-16 = S  
KEY 25-32 = S  
D:DESTINATION  
SET BLOCK NUMBER=3  
MOTHER STATION BLOCK LIST  
BLOCK 1 = STATION 11 | BLOCK 6 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = STATION 5  
BLOCK 3 = STATION 2  
BLOCK 4 = STATION 3  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
Contents to be set are shown below.  
DISPLAY MODE  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
STATUS = Indicates the status of the primary station’s  
crosspoint table.  
Example of Setting Screen (BKS-R3205)  
PROMPT = The depressed button lit immediately.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R3206 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 2  
PROTECT MODE  
SET PANEL STATUS  
ON AIR = Switching is performed from that panel even  
after protected.  
NORMAL = Switching is prohibited after protected.  
FLEXIBLE =Switching is prohibited after protected.  
However, protections by other stations can  
be released.*1  
PANEL MODE = 2  
1:STAND ALONE  
PANEL LAYOUT = 2  
2:MOTHER  
1: KEY + NUMBER SELECT MODE  
2: SOURCE DIRECT SELECT MODE  
SET BLOCK NUMBER = 2  
MOTHER STATION BLOCK LIST  
FLEX & OA =Uses the functions of both 1 : ON AIR  
and 3 : FLEXIBLE. *1  
BLOCK 1 = STATION 11 | BLOCK 6 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = STATION 5  
BLOCK 3 = STATION 2  
BLOCK 4 = STATION 3  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
PHANTOM PROTECT  
PART PROT = The phantoms that are not protected are  
switched.  
Example of Setting Screen (BKS-R3206)  
FULL PROT = All phantoms cannot be switched when  
even one phantom on which protect is  
set to on, is included.  
BUTTON LINK = All phantoms cannot be switched  
when the protect button is set to on.  
PANEL MODE  
STAND ALONE = Stand alone panel  
MOTHER = Mother panel  
DAUGHTER = Daughter panel  
PANEL LAYOUT*2  
TYPE + NUM. = Selection of X-Y  
DIRECT = Direct selection*3  
BPS = Source button selection*1  
KEYPAD = Description selection*1  
(Only BKS-R3216 is valid.)  
*1 : It is only applicable to BKS-R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621.  
*2 : It is only applicable to BKS-R3210/R3216.  
*3 : BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210  
5-43  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
LEVEL MODE*1  
Setting Procedure  
SINGLE = Single level selection  
MULTI = Multiple level selection  
1. Select the menu item [Z].  
2. The cursor appears in “DISPLAY MODE = 1”.  
Move the cursor to an arbitrary mode and press  
[Enter] establishes the input mode.  
DEST SELECTION*2  
DISABLE = Change of destination from the panel is  
3. Enter a number to select using the ten-keys.  
When [Enter] is pressed to confirm the input number,  
the cursor moves to the next setting item.  
When you do not want to change the default value, do  
not input any number, but press [Enter].  
prohibited.  
ENABLE = Change of destination from the panel is  
allowed.  
ILLUMINATION LEVEL*3  
Brightness of the button indicator : 1 (dark) to 8 (bright)  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL STATUS  
BKS-R3220 V1.03  
STATION NUMBER 2  
DISPLAY MODE  
PROTECT MODE  
PHANTOM PROTECT  
PANEL MODE  
= 1  
= 2  
= 1  
= 1  
= 1  
= 1  
= *  
1:STATUS  
2:PROMPT  
2:NORMAL  
MONITOR DESTINATION*3  
Enter the name of the destination to be monitored (when  
the MONI button is selected).  
1:ON AIR  
3:FLEXIBLE 4:FLEX & OA  
1:PART PROT  
2:FULL PROT 3:BUTTON LINK  
1:STAND ALONE 2:MOTHER  
1:TYPE + NUM. 2:BPS  
3:DAUGHTER  
3:KEYPAD  
PANEL LAYOUT  
LEVEL MODE  
*:UNRELATED  
1:SINGLE  
2:MULTI  
*:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
DEST SELECTION  
1:DISABLE  
1-8:MIN-MAX  
2:ENABLE  
ILLUMINATION LEVEL = 8  
SOURCE OFFSET*3  
0 = Use the same source as the destination to be monitored.  
1 to 1023 = Use the source at the specified offset.  
MONITOR DESTINATION = .......  
SOURCE OFFSET  
CONTROL LEVELS  
= 0000  
= --------  
BLOCK & MOTHER STATION LIST  
BLOCK 1 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = .......  
BLOCK 3 = .......  
BLOCK 4 = .......  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 6 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
CONTROL LEVELS*3  
When you want to select any specific level from remote  
control unit, move the cursor to the desired level and  
press [Enter]. (When you want to select level-3, move  
the cursor to the third “_” position and press [Enter].)  
_” = : Level selection will not be performed.  
Other than “_” : A signal will be switched at the level.  
When all indications show “_”, a signal is switched at  
the level which is set by the primary station.  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Example of Setting Screen  
4. Set the respective items in the same way as the steps 2  
and 3.  
However, set “PANEL MODE” (setting the mother  
and daughters panels) as follows.  
*1 : It is only applicable to BKS-R3210/R3216.  
*2 : It is only applicable to BKS-R1607/R1617.  
*3 : It is only applicable to BKS-R3216/R1617/R1618/R3219/R3220/R1621.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
Mother panel :  
n
1) Select “PANEL MODE = 2” (mother machine).  
2) Press [Enter].  
Checksum can be displayed from version V1.10 of the  
BKS series.  
The following contents are displayed on the setting screen.  
Use checksum to check if the program data is correct,  
in addition to the version number indication. (The  
PGM CHECKSUM is mainly used.)  
SET BLOCK NUMBER = *  
MOTHER STATION BLOCK LIST  
BLOCK 1 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = .......  
BLOCK 3 = .......  
BLOCK 4 = .......  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 6 = .......  
The following three types of checksum are available.  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
BOOT CHECKSUM=D039  
Checksum of the program area that is used for starting  
up the ROM.  
3) Input the unused BLOCK number of the BLOCK &  
MOTHER STATION LIST into the “*” column.  
4) Press [Enter] to confirm the input contents.  
PGM CHECKSUM=630F  
Check of the area in which the actual programs are  
stored.  
ROM CHECKSUM=FF68  
Daughter panel :  
1) Select “PANEL MODE = 3” (daughter panel).  
2) Press [Enter].  
Checksum of the entire ROM.  
The following contents are displayed on the setting screen.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL STATUS  
BKS-R3210 V1.10  
STATION NUMBER 6  
DISPLAY MODE  
PROTECT MODE  
= 1  
= 2  
1:STATUS  
1:ON AIR  
2:PROMPT  
2:NORMAL  
MOTHER STATION ID = **  
MOTHER STATION BLOCK LIST  
BLOCK 1 = STATION 6  
(The designated ID is not found)  
PHANTOM PROTECT = 1  
1:PART PROT  
2:FULL PROT  
3:BUTTON LINK  
3:DAUGHTER  
| BLOCK 6 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
PANEL MODE  
PANEL LAYOUT  
LEVEL MODE  
= 1  
= 2  
= 1  
1:STAND ALONE 2:MOTHER  
1:TYPE + NUM. 2:DIRECT  
BLOCK 2 = .......  
BLOCK 3 = .......  
BLOCK 4 = .......  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
*:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
1:SINGLE  
2:MULTI  
DEST SELECTION = *  
1:DISABLE  
2:ENABLE  
BLOCK & MOTHER STATION LIST  
BLOCK 1 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = .......  
BLOCK 3 = .......  
BLOCK 4 = .......  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 6 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
3) Input the mother’s STATION ID number of the  
BLOCK & MOTHER STATION LIST into the “**”  
column.  
BOOT CHECKSUM=D039 PGM CHECKSUM=630F ROM CHECKSUM=FF68  
4) Press [Enter].  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN  
When the ID number is input correctly, model name of  
the mother panel appears as shown below.  
Example of Setting Screen  
MOTHER STATION ID = 6  
(BKS-R1607)  
5. Pressing [Ctrl] _ [E] switches to the menu display of  
the secondary station.  
Pressing [Ctrl] _ [D] returns to the menu display of  
the primary station.  
m
1. Various modes must be set individually on the units on  
which mother panel and daughter panels are set.  
2. Set the mother panel first when setting the mother  
panel and daughter panel.  
3. Setting of the mother panel and daughter panel is not  
completed when the “PANEL MODE” setting alone is  
performed.  
Be sure to set the block numbers of mother panel and  
to set the STATION ID (MOTHER ID) of the daugh-  
ter panel side.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2. Setting Items of the Secondary Station  
Z : SELECT CONNECTION (DVS-RS1616 only)  
Z : SWITCHING FIELD (HDS-V3232 only)  
Purpose  
Purpose  
As for DVS-RS1616, this menu is used to set, “M”  
(controlling side) or “S” (controlled side) for each 9-pin  
connector from 1 to 32.  
This menu is used to set the crosspoint switching field of  
HDS-V3232 with the control terminal.  
If a controller is connected to a 9-pin connector, set to (S).  
If a controlled device is connected to a 9-pin connector, set  
to (M).  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select the menu item [Z].  
2. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to stop the display and the menu  
screen of the secondary station will be displayed.  
When setting to (S), termination is automatically made.  
SWITCHING FIELD  
HDS-V3232 V2.10 STATION NUMBER 1  
DVS-RS1616  
EDITOR,  
etc (M)  
VTR,  
etc (S)  
(S)  
(M)  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select the menu item [Z].  
2. Select a input/output number using the cursor.  
3. Press [Enter], the setting status changes.  
(“M” “S” “M”)  
4. Press [S] (TABLE SET), the content now appeared is  
copied to the table data.  
SWITCHING FIELD  
FIELD  
F2:FIELD  
S:Table Set Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
5. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to stop the display and the menu  
screen of the secondary station will be displayed.  
Example of Setting Screen  
n
SELECT CONNECTION  
OUTPUT (INPUT)  
DVS-RS1616 V3.01 STATION NUMBER 5  
INPUT  
Unless pressing [S], the data will be deleted when the  
power is turned off.  
TERMINAL:DIRECTION TERMINAL:DIRECTION TERMINAL:DIRECTION TERMINAL:DIRECTION  
01(17): M  
02(18): M  
03(19): M  
:
09(25): M  
10(26): M  
11(27): M  
01 : S  
02 : S  
03 : S  
09 : S  
10 : S  
11 : S  
:
Operating Function Key  
[F2] : FIELD (Mode which sets the crosspoint switching  
field)  
:
:
08(24): M  
16(32): M  
08 : S  
16 : S  
1. Press [F2]. The cursor will move to “SWITCH  
ING FIELD” in the menu.  
S:TABLE SET  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
2. Press [Enter]. The setting will change.  
(ODD EVEN FIELD ASYNC ODD)  
All switching field in the switcher are deter  
mined by this setting.  
Example of Setting Screen  
n
Unless pressing [S], the setting will be ignore.  
n
To use RS-422A and S-BUS together, set the switching  
field as follows.  
1 When using the S-BUS and CART protocol together :  
ODD  
2 When using the S-BUS and PRODUCTION  
SWITCHER protocol together : FIELD  
Note that the switching timing of the CART will not be  
accurate if the CART and PRODUCTION SWITCHERS  
protocols are used together.  
Switching timing is not guaranteed in the combination of  
different switching fields.  
For details of the signal switching timing, refer to “5-8.  
Signal Switching Timing”.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-3. Setting Items of the Primary Station on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3292B only)  
5-3. Setting Items of the Primary Station  
on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3292B  
only)  
F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
Purpose  
This menu is used to enable the units connected to the data  
link of the monitor S-BUS to communicate.  
Used for setting the units on the monitor S-BUS.  
SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
DVS-V6464B Monitor Bus I/F V2.10  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
F: SET SCTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [F].  
2. Select the secondary station using the cursor whose  
communication will be valid.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the setting displayed will  
change “E” “Blank” “E”. Only the secondary  
stations displayed with “E” are valid. (“M” indicates  
the primary station.)  
M: SELECT MONITOR FUNCTION (COMBINED)  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Menu Screen of the Primary Station on Monitor S-BUS  
4. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the menu screen of the  
primary station on the monitor S-BUS will be dis-  
played.  
Setting Procedure of Monitor Function  
1. Select the menu item [R] of the primary station in  
order to call the menu screen of the secondary station  
set as the primary station on the monitor S-BUS.  
2. Select the menu item [M] to call the menu screen of  
the primary station on the monitor S-BUS.  
3. Set the menu item [F] and [M].  
n
As the response will become slower if there are many  
secondary stations, make the secondary stations not  
connected invalid.  
*” indicates out of the control area.  
4. Select the menu item [R] to call the secondary station  
on the monitor S-BUS.  
ENABLE ACTIVE UNIT FOR STATION NUMBER  
DVS-V6464B Monitor Bus I/F V2.10  
5. Set each menu item on the screen.  
6. Press [Ctrl] _ [Z] to return to the menu screen of the  
primary station on the monitor S-BUS.  
7. Set each item of all secondary stations, repeating the  
procedure of step 4 to 6.  
8. Press [Ctrl] _ [D] to return to the menu screen of the  
primary station on the standard S-BUS.  
1 2 3 4 5  
+
6 7 8 9 10 1112131415 1617181920  
001-020  
021-040  
041-060  
061-080  
081-100  
101-120  
121-140  
141-160  
161-180  
181-200  
201-220  
221-240  
241-254  
M E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
E E E E E  
n
*
*
*
*
* *  
If there are multiple monitor S-BUS data links, repeat the  
CTRL-E:RETURN TO MENU  
procedure of step 1 to 8 for each link.  
Example of Setting Screen  
m
1. Station ID of the primary station is always 1 regardless  
of the DIP switch setting on the CPU board.  
2. Station ID of the secondary station is deter mined with  
the DIP switch setting. Do not assign the same  
number on two or more units as station ID on both  
standard S-BUS and monitor S-BUS.  
Number that can be registered as secondary s station  
ID are 2 to 254.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-3. Setting Items of the Primary Station on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3292B only)  
M: SELECT MONITOR FUNCTION  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu is for setting the connection to use the input  
monitor and output monitor in series or independently.  
To monitor the input and output monitor lines using  
separate monitors, set the SEPARATED mode. To  
monitor them together on one monitor, set the COM-  
BINED mode.  
This menu is used to call the secondary station on the  
monitor S-BUS.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [R].  
2. Enter the station number using the numerical keys, and  
press [Enter] to call it.  
Setting Procedure  
3. The menu screen of the secondary station on the  
1. Select menu item [M].  
monitor S-BUS will be displayed.  
The following appears.  
COMBINED : series connection  
SEPARATED : independent use  
2. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to display the menu screen of the  
primary station on the monitor S-BUS.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-4. Setting Items of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3293B only)  
5-4. Setting Items of the Secondary  
Station on Monitor S-BUS  
(BKDS-V3293B only)  
L : COPY TABLE DATA <MONITOR MENU>  
Purpose  
This menu is used to copy the setting contents of the  
remote control unit. This is applied to BKS-R3204 and  
BKS-R3205.  
M: SET AVAILABLE MONITOR LINE  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B + BKDS-R3292B)  
Setting Procedure  
SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
DVS-V6464B Monitor Bus I/F V2.10 STATION NUMBER 23  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
1. Select menu item [L]. This item can be selected from  
both the menu and another setting screen.  
2. The message “Station Number?” will be displayed.  
Enter the station number to be copied.  
M: SET AVAILABLE MONITOR LINE INPUT=( ENABLE )OUTPUT=( ENABLE )  
Ctrl-Z:RETURN  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the table data will be copied  
and the screen will return to the setting screen.  
When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed again, the menu screen  
of the secondary station on the monitor S-BUS will be  
displayed.  
Menu Screen of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS  
(DVS-V3232B/V6464B)  
Purpose  
This menu is used to set the input monitor and output  
monitor to valid or invalid.  
4. When [Ctrl] _ [Z] is pressed, menu screen of the  
primary station on the monitor S-BUS will be dis-  
played.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [M].  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU.  
BKS-R3204 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 6  
2. Select the source/destination using the cursor, and  
press [Enter] to change the setting. (“ENABLE” →  
“DISABLE” “ENABLE”)  
3. Press [Ctrl] _ [Z] to display the menu screen of the  
primary station on the monitor S-BUS.  
Station Number ?  
Ctrl-Z:RETURN  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Input Monitor  
Input Monitor  
Example of Setting Screen  
65  
64  
1
128  
1
Data set on the menu item [N : SET PANEL TABLE] are  
copied.  
E
E
Cascade  
D
E
Output  
Monitor  
DVS-V6464B  
Cascade  
DVS-V6464B  
Cascade  
64  
65  
D
Cascade  
Output  
E
Monitor  
DVS-V6464B  
DVS-V6464B  
128  
E : Enable  
D : Disable  
n
Be sure to set the monitor line to “DISABLE” in cascade  
connection.  
If set to “ENABLE”, the monitor may not be performed  
properly.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-4. Setting Items of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3293B only)  
N: SET PANEL TABLE (BKS-R1607/R1608/R3204/R3205/R3209/R3210) <MONITOR MENU>  
Purpose  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R1607 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 3  
This menu is used to assign source/destination name to  
each source/destination selection button.  
SET PANEL TABLE(SOURCE)  
CONTROL DESTINATION = OUT001  
01 KEY=IN001  
05 KEY=IN005  
02 KEY=IN002  
06 KEY=IN006  
03 KEY=IN003  
07 KEY=IN007  
04 KEY=IN004  
08 KEY=IN008  
In the monitor mode, the button color of the remote control  
unit will be green for both source and destination.  
09 KEY=....... 10 KEY=....... 11 KEY=....... 12 KEY=.......  
13 KEY=....... 14 KEY=....... 15 KEY=....... 16 KEY=.......  
17 KEY=IN009  
21 KEY=IN013  
18 KEY=IN010  
22 KEY=IN014  
19 KEY=IN011  
23 KEY=IN015  
20 KEY=IN012  
24 KEY=IN016  
25 KEY=....... 26 KEY=....... 27 KEY=....... 28 KEY=.......  
29 KEY=....... 30 KEY=....... 31 KEY=....... 32 KEY=.......  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item [N].  
SET PANEL TABLE(DESTINATION)  
2. Select a button number using the cursor.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the name can be typed.  
To delete the registration, press [Enter] before  
inputting the name.  
4. a) When [J : NAME STYLE (Type + Num)] is  
selected in the primary station menu, input the  
type name (between 0 and F) and the number for  
the source and destination.  
01 KEY=....... 02 KEY=....... 03 KEY=....... 04 KEY=.......  
05 KEY=....... 06 KEY=....... 07 KEY=....... 08 KEY=.......  
09 KEY=OUT001  
13 KEY=OUT005  
10 KEY=OUT002  
14 KEY=OUT006  
11 KEY=OUT003  
15 KEY=OUT007  
12 KEY=OUT004  
16 KEY=OUT008  
17 KEY=....... 18 KEY=....... 19 KEY=....... 20 KEY=.......  
21 KEY=....... 22 KEY=....... 23 KEY=....... 24 KEY=.......  
25 KEY=OUT009  
29 KEY=OUT013  
26 KEY=OUT010  
30 KEY=OUT014  
27 KEY=OUT011  
31 KEY=OUT015  
28 KEY=OUT012  
32 KEY=OUT016  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
2=.... 3=.... 4=.... 5=.... 6=.... 7=....  
8=.... 9=.... A=.... B=.... C=.... D=.... E=.... F=....  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Ctrl-N:Type + Num  
b) Each time [Ctrl] _ [N] is pressed when [J :  
NAME STYLE (DESCRIP. NAME)] is selected  
in the primary station menu, the following input  
modes will be switched alternately.  
Example of Setting Screen  
m
1. Set the table data of BKS-R3204/R3205/R3206 by  
eight buttons previously in the menu item [Z : SET  
____ PANEL STATUS]. If “KEY = ____” is  
displayed on the key number position, the name can  
not be input.  
2. Be sure to set either source or destination on the  
respective buttons (keys) when setting the BKS-  
R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210.  
Description name input mode :  
When “Ctrl N: Type + Num” is displayed on the  
screen, it means that the name mode will be changed  
to “Type + Number” by pressing [Ctrl] _ [N].  
Inputs the Description name from the first to seventh  
characters with alphabet and numerical keys.  
“Type + Number” name input mode :  
Same as a)  
If both source and destination are set to the same  
button (key), it will cause malfunction.  
3. When setting description names to the source/destina-  
tion buttons, select a name from the description name  
group sent to the remote control unit.  
n
If the Description name has been set for the input/output  
number the display of Description has priority to the  
display of “Type + Number” even if the “Type + Number”  
name is input.  
If other names are input, these will not be set even if  
the [Enter] button is pressed.  
In such cases, transfer the group including the desired  
description name from the primary station.  
5. When [Enter] is pressed, the source name is set.  
6. When [Ctrl] _ [E] is pressed, the screen will return to  
the menu screen of the secondary station on the  
monitor S-BUS.  
When [Ctrl] _ [Z] is pressed, the screen will return to  
the menu screen of the primary station on the monitor  
S-BUS.  
When [Ctrl] _ [D] is pressed, the screen will return to  
the menu screen of the primary station on the standard  
S-BUS.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-4. Setting Items of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3293B only)  
S : DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
<MONITOR MENU>  
n
In BKS-R1607 of version V1.10 and higher, any  
desired button among the sixteen buttons can be set as  
a TAKE button.  
Purpose  
Check the groups and their names of the description names  
that are transferred from the primary station.  
When this setting is performed, the name selected by  
the SELECTOR knob on the front panel can be taken  
by pressing the TAKE button.  
Check Procedure  
1. Press either [Enter] or [SPACE] to view the next  
page.  
(Maximum inputs 512 x outputs 512)  
2. Press either [BS] or [DEL] to view the previous page.  
3. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
The actual setting procedure is as follows. Select a  
key from the source side which you want to use as the  
TAKE button. Press the [T] button.  
Press [Ctrl] _ [D] to return to the menu screen of the  
primary station.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
BKS-R1607 V1.10 STATION NUMBER 12  
SET PANEL TABLE(SOURCE) CONTROL DESTINATION = OUT244  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
GROUP No. = 1  
BKS-R3206 V3.10 STATION NUMBER 16  
01 KEY=SRC004  
05 KEY=SRC002  
09 KEY=SRC009  
13 KEY=.......  
02 KEY=SRC005  
03 KEY=SRC006  
07 KEY=SRC007  
11 KEY=SRC013  
15 KEY=.......  
04 KEY=SRC001  
06 KEY=SRC003  
10 KEY=SRC010  
14 KEY=.......  
08 KEY=SRC008  
12 KEY=SRC014  
16 KEY=TAKE  
No. Terminal Name  
Description Name  
No. Terminal Name  
Description Name  
1 DST- 001 OUT001 London  
2 DST- 002 OUT002 NewYork  
3 SRC- 001 IN001  
5 SRC- 003 IN003  
7 SRC- 005 IN005  
9 SRC- 007 IN007  
Berlin  
Tokyo  
4 SRC- 002 IN002  
6 SRC- 004 IN004  
8 SRC- 006 IN006  
Moscow  
Cairo  
SET PANEL TABLE(DESTINATION)  
Berjing  
Tpronto  
Madrid  
01 KEY=.......  
05 KEY=.......  
09 KEY=.......  
13 KEY=OUT001  
02 KEY=.......  
06 KEY=.......  
10 KEY=.......  
14 KEY=OUT012  
03 KEY=.......  
07 KEY=.......  
11 KEY=.......  
15 KEY=OUT003  
04 KEY=.......  
08 KEY=.......  
12 KEY=.......  
16 KEY=.......  
10 DST- 005 OUT005 Paris  
12 DST- 012 VTR012 OUT012  
14 DST- 014 VTR014 OUT014  
16 DST- 016 SONY016 OUT016  
18 DST- 018 VTR018 OUT018  
20 DST- 020 VTR020 OUT020  
22 DST- 022 VTR022 OUT022  
24 DST- 024 VTR024 OUT024  
26 DST- 026 VTR026 OUT026  
28 DST- 028 VTR028 OUT028  
30 DST- 030 VTR030 OUT030  
32 DST- 032 VTR032 OUT032  
34 DST- 034 VTR034 OUT034  
36 DST- 036 VTR036 OUT036  
38 DST- 038 VTR038 OUT038  
40 DST- 040 VTR040 OUT040  
11 DST- 008 OUT008 Rome  
13 DST- 013 VTR013 OUT013  
15 DST- 015 VTR015 OUT015  
17 DST- 017 VTR017 OUT017  
19 DST- 019 VTR019 OUT019  
21 DST- 021 VTR021 OUT021  
23 DST- 023 VTR023 OUT023  
25 DST- 025 VTR025 OUT025  
27 DST- 027 VTR027 OUT027  
29 DST- 029 VTR029 OUT029  
31 DST- 031 VTR031 OUT031  
33 DST- 033 VTR033 OUT033  
35 DST- 035 VTR035 OUT035  
37 DST- 037 VTR037 OUT037  
39 DST- 039 VTR039 OUT039  
0=SRC  
8=8  
1=OUT  
9=9  
2=2  
A=A  
3=3  
B=B  
4=4  
C=C  
5=5  
D=D  
6=6  
E=E  
7=7  
F=F  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Ctrl-N:DESCRIP.NAME T:TAKE  
Example of Setting Screen  
Ctrl-E:MENU  
Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Ctrl-H:Pg-Up  
Ctrl-M:Pg-Dn  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-4. Setting Items of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3293B only)  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS (BKS-R1607/R1608/  
R3204/R3205/R3209/R3210)  
n
<MONITOR MENU>  
In BKS-R1607/R1608/R3209/R3210 of version V1.10 and  
higher, the 160 description names that are transferred from  
the primary station can be registered in the range of inputs  
512 x outputs 512 in the order of terminal number regard-  
less of the block number. When you want to use more than  
160 of the description names, transmit the names from the  
primary station after dividing the description names into  
Purpose  
Set the various modes of the remote control unit.  
Number of sources and destinations that can be controlled  
from the remote control unit, can be expanded by connect-  
ing multiple mother and daughter panels. Setting the  
mother and daughter panels are also performed using this  
menu. (Ten mother panels can be registered at the maxi-  
mum.)  
several blocks.  
The following operations are possible from the screen.  
Look at destination from source side : [*] key  
Look at source from destination side : [&] key  
The setting contents are as follows.  
DISPLAY MODE  
Return to the previous page :  
Move to the next page :  
[(] key  
[)] key  
STATUS= Displays the status of the primary station  
crosspoint table.  
PROMPT= The pressed buttons lit immediately.  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SOURCE  
BKS-R3210 V1.10  
STATION NUMBER 6  
PROTECT MODE  
ON AIR= Execute switching from the panel even during  
the protect mode.  
NORMAL= Switching is not possible during the protect  
mode.  
name  
1 IN001  
3 IN003  
5 IN005  
7 IN007  
9 IN009  
11 IN011  
13 IN013  
15 IN015  
17 IN017  
19 IN019  
21 IN021  
23 IN023  
25 IN025  
27 IN027  
29 IN029  
31 IN031  
Description  
CAM001  
CAM003  
VTR005  
VTR007  
ONAIR01  
ONAIR03  
STADIO1  
STADIO3  
MONI001  
IN019  
name  
2 IN002  
4 IN004  
6 IN006  
8 IN008  
10 IN010  
12 IN012  
14 IN014  
16 IN016  
18 IN018  
20 IN020  
22 IN022  
24 IN024  
26 IN026  
28 IN028  
30 IN030  
32 IN032  
Description  
CAM002  
CAM004  
VTR006  
VTR008  
ONAIR02  
ONAIR04  
STADIO2  
STADIO4  
MONI002  
IN020  
PHANTOM PROTECT  
PART PROT= Execute switching on the phantom on  
which protect is not set.  
FULL PROT=Switching is not executed on all phantoms  
when any of the phantom is set to PRO-  
TECT ON.  
IN021  
IN022  
IN023  
IN024  
IN025  
IN026  
IN027  
IN028  
IN029  
IN030  
IN031  
IN032  
BUTTON LINK=Switching is not executed on all  
phantoms when the PROTECT button  
on the panel is set to ON.  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Right:DESTINATION Left:SOURCE  
Example of Setting Screen  
PANEL MODE*3  
STAND ALONE= Stand alone panel  
MOTHER= Mother panel  
DAUGHTER= Daughter panel  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
DESTINATION  
BKS-R3210 V1.10  
STATION NUMBER 6  
name  
Description  
name  
Description  
1 OUT001 DST001  
3 OUT003 DST003  
5 OUT005 DST005  
7 OUT007 DST007  
9 OUT009 OUT009  
11 OUT011 OUT011  
13 OUT013 OUT013  
15 OUT015 OUT015  
17 OUT017 OUT017  
19 OUT019 OUT019  
21 OUT021 OUT021  
23 OUT023 OUT023  
25 OUT025 OUT025  
27 OUT027 OUT027  
29 OUT029 OUT029  
31 OUT031 OUT031  
2 OUT002 DST002  
4 OUT004 DST004  
6 OUT006 DST006  
8 OUT008 DST008  
10 OUT010 OUT010  
12 OUT012 OUT012  
14 OUT014 OUT014  
16 OUT016 OUT016  
18 OUT018 OUT018  
20 OUT020 OUT020  
22 OUT022 OUT022  
24 OUT024 OUT024  
26 OUT026 OUT026  
28 OUT028 OUT028  
30 OUT030 OUT030  
32 OUT032 OUT032  
PANEL LAYOUT*1  
TYPE + NUM.= Selecting X-Y  
DIRECT= Selecting direct  
LEVEL MODE*1  
SINGLE= Selecting a single level  
MULTI= Selecting multiple levels  
DEST SELECTION*2  
DISABLE=The destination change from panel is  
disabled.  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN Right:DESTINATION Left:SOURCE  
ENABLE=The destination change from panel is enabled.  
Example of Setting Screen  
*1: Applicable to BKS-R3210 only.  
*2: Applicable to BKS-R1607 only.  
*3: When monitor S-BUS is used, select STAND ALONE= Stand alone  
machine at all times since mother-daughter setting is not necessary.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-4. Setting Items of the Secondary Station on Monitor S-BUS (BKDS-V3293B only)  
Setting Procedure  
n
1. Select menu item [Z].  
Checksum can be displayed from version V1.10 of the  
2. The cursor appears at “DISPLAY MODE=1.”  
Move the cursor to the desired mode. (Use the keys  
[(], [)].) Press [Enter] to enter the input mode.  
3. Input the number to be selected using the numerical  
keys.  
BKS series.  
Use checksum to check if the program data is correct,  
in addition to the version number indication. (The  
PGM CHECKSUM is mainly used.)  
The following three types of checksum are available.  
Press [Enter] to set the input number. The cursor  
moves to the setting item.  
When you want to modify the default value, press  
[Enter] without inputting any number.  
BOOT CHECKSUM=D039  
Checksum of the program area that is used for starting  
up the ROM.  
PGM CHECKSUM=630F  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL STATUS  
BKS-R1607 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 7  
Check of the area in which the actual programs are  
stored.  
ROM CHECKSUM=FF68  
DISPLAY MODE  
PROTECT MODE  
= 1  
= 2  
1:STATUS  
2:PROMPT  
2:NORMAL  
1:ON AIR  
PHANTOM PROTECT = 1  
1:PART PROT  
2:FULL PROT  
3:BUTTON LINK  
3:DAUGHTER  
Checksum of the entire ROM.  
PANEL MODE  
PANEL LAYOUT  
LEVEL MODE  
= 1  
= *  
= *  
1:STAND ALONE 2:MOTHER  
1:TYPE + NUM. 2:DIRECT  
*:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
MONITOR SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
SET PANEL STATUS  
BKS-R3210 V1.10  
STATION NUMBER 6  
1:SINGLE  
2:MULTI  
DEST SELECTION = 1  
1:DISABLE  
2:ENABLE  
DISPLAY MODE  
PROTECT MODE  
= 1  
= 2  
1:STATUS  
2:PROMPT  
1:ON AIR  
2:NORMAL  
PHANTOM PROTECT = 1  
1:PART PROT  
2:FULL PROT  
3:BUTTON LINK  
3:DAUGHTER  
PANEL MODE  
PANEL LAYOUT  
LEVEL MODE  
= 1  
= 2  
= 1  
1:STAND ALONE 2:MOTHER  
1:TYPE + NUM. 2:DIRECT  
*:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
*:UNRELATED  
1:SINGLE  
2:MULTI  
BLOCK & MOTHER STATION LIST  
DEST SELECTION = *  
1:DISABLE  
2:ENABLE  
BLOCK 1 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = .......  
BLOCK 3 = .......  
BLOCK 4 = .......  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 6 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
BLOCK & MOTHER STATION LIST  
BLOCK 1 = .......  
BLOCK 2 = .......  
BLOCK 3 = .......  
BLOCK 4 = .......  
BLOCK 5 = .......  
| BLOCK 6 = .......  
| BLOCK 7 = .......  
| BLOCK 8 = .......  
| BLOCK 9 = .......  
| BLOCK10 = .......  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN  
BOOT CHECKSUM=D039 PGM CHECKSUM=630F ROM CHECKSUM=FF68  
Example of Setting Screen  
Ctrl-E:MENU Ctrl-D:RETURN  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-5. Backup of Setting Data  
5-6. When Data is Lost  
5-5. Backup of Setting Data  
The data set using the control terminal will be stored in the RAM on the CPU board. It is however  
recommended that the setting data be backed up just in case the data is damaged or lost.  
Data can be backed up easily by using the Sony routing switcher system control software BZR-1000 (run  
with a IBM PC/AT or compatible machine) or BZR-10.  
5-6. When Data is Lost  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B  
If the LED (D7) on the CPU board is not lit even if the error No. indicator shows “00” when operations  
are being checked, it means that all the data set have been lost.  
The first thing to do is to check the setting of COR1 on the CPU board.  
OFF : Set to ON position.  
ON : The lithium battery (BT1) may be defective.  
Measure voltage across BT1. If it is 2V or less, replace it with the new one.  
Consult with your Sony Sales Representative for replacement of battery.  
Next, initialize the unit as following procedures.  
1. Set the COR1 on the CPU-149 board to ON.  
2. Set the test switch (S3) to “D” and press the reset switch (S5).  
3. Set the test switch (S3) to “0” and press the reset switch (S5).  
4. Call the menu screen on the control terminal and execute the menu item [T : SET CLOCK].  
BKPF-R70  
If the LED (D2) on the CPU board is not lit even if the error No. indicator shows “00” when operations  
are being checked, it means that all the data set have been lost.  
The lithium battery (BT1) may be defective.  
Measure voltage across BT1. If it is 2V or less, replace it with the new one (CR-2025).  
Consult with your Sony Sales Representative for replacement of battery.  
HDS-V3232  
If the LED (D13) on the CPU board is not lit even if the error No. indicator shows “00” when operations  
are being checked, it means that all the data set have been lost.  
The first thing to do is to check the setting of the CN5 on the CPU board.  
OFF : Set to ON position.  
ON : The lithium battery (BT1) may be defective.  
Measure voltage across BT1. If it is 2V or less, replace it with the new one.  
Consult with your Sony Sales Representative for replacement of battery.  
Next, initialize the unit as following procedures.  
1. Set the COR1 on the CPU-251 board to ON.  
2. Set the test switch (S2) to “D” and press the reset switch (S8).  
3. Set the test switch (S2) to “0” and press the reset switch (S8).  
4. Call the menu screen on the control terminal and execute the menu item [T : SET CLOCK].  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-7. Initialization of Table Data  
5-7. Initialization of Table Data  
There are five ways of initializing the table data. Note that the way to be used depends on which item is  
initialized.  
5-7-1. Initializing Procedure and Corresponding Items  
DVS-V3232B/V6464B :  
Initializing Procedure  
Corresponding Menu Items  
1
2
3
1. Set the test switch (S3) on the CPU-149 board to “D”.  
2. Press the reset switch (S5).  
All items of the primary and secondary stations.  
1. Set the test switch (S3) on the CPU-149 board to “C”.  
2. Press the reset switch (S5).  
[W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
Select the menu item [K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE]  
of the primary station and press [Y].  
All items of the primary station excluding the  
following 4 items.  
. [H : SET GLOBAL PHANTOM]  
. [N : SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP]  
. [O : SET TIE LINES]  
. [W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
4
5
Select the menu item [K : reset To default table]  
of the secondary station and press [Y].  
All items of the secondary station excluding  
the crosspoint data.  
Select the menu item [U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL] [U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL]  
of the secondary station and press [F2] (DEFAULT).  
BKPF-R70 :  
Initializing Procedure  
Corresponding Menu Items  
1
2
3
1. Set the test switch (S5) on the CPU-256 board to “D”.  
2. Press the reset switch (S1).  
All items of the primary and secondary stations.  
1. Set the test switch (S5) on the CPU-256 board to “C”.  
2. Press the reset switch (S1).  
[W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
Select the menu item [K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE]  
of the primary station and press [Y].  
All items of the primary station excluding the  
following 4 items.  
. [H : SET GLOBAL PHANTOM]  
. [N : SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP]  
. [O : SET TIE LINES]  
. [W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
4
5
Select the menu item [K : reset To default table]  
of the secondary station and press [Y].  
All items of the secondary station excluding  
the crosspoint data.  
Select the menu item [U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL] [U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL]  
of the secondary station and press [F2] (DEFAULT).  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-7. Initialization of Table Data  
HDS-V3232 :  
Initializing Procedure  
Corresponding Menu Items  
1
2
3
1. Set the test switch (S2) on the CPU-251 board to “D”.  
2. Press the reset switch (S8).  
All items of the primary and secondary stations.  
1. Set the test switch (S2) on the CPU-251 board to “C”.  
2. Press the reset switch (S8).  
[W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
Select the menu item [K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE]  
of the primary station and press [Y].  
All items of the primary station excluding the  
following 4 items.  
. [H : SET GLOBAL PHANTOM]  
. [N : SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP]  
. [O : SET TIE LINES]  
. [W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
4
5
Select the menu item [K : reset To default table]  
of the secondary station and press [Y].  
All items of the secondary station excluding  
the crosspoint data.  
Select the menu item [U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL] [U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL]  
of the secondary station and press [F2] (DEFAULT).  
n
The primary station of HDS-V3232 does not have the menu item[S].  
The secondary station of the menu item [Z] of [SWITCHING FIELD] only.  
5-7-2. Default Values Initialization  
Item  
Default Value  
Primary station  
[B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE]  
TYPE : 0=IN, 1=OUT, 2-F=None  
NAME : IN001-IN512, OUT001-OUT512  
[E : SET LEVEL TABLE]  
All levels of all destination is ENABLE  
Level name : 1, 2, 3....7, 8  
[F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER]  
DVS-V3232B : STATION 2-33 ENABLE  
DVS-V6464B : STATION 2-65 ENABLE  
[H : SET GLOBAL PHANTOM]  
[J : NAME STYLE]  
Not set  
Type + Num (“Type + Number” name mode)  
Physical location number=Virtual location number  
Not set  
[L : SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT]  
[M : SET INHIBIT TABLE]  
[N : SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP]  
[O : SET TIE LINES]  
[P : CHANGE PASSWORD]  
[S : SELECT INDICATION COLOR]  
[U : SELECT CONTROL MODE]  
[V : SELECT WARNING DISPLAY]  
[W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
OFF  
All channels : DIRECT  
OFF  
NO LOG  
[Z : SET UNIT DETECTABLE]  
All STATION : OFF  
No OFFSET  
Secondary station [A : SET UNIT LOCATION ]  
[U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL]  
[Z : SELECT SDI FORMAT]  
The input /output number is 1:1.  
4:2:2, SWITCHING FIELD=FIELD  
The input/output number is 1:1.  
Crosspoint data  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-8. Signal Switching Timing  
5-8. Signal Switching Timing  
For DVS-V3232B/V6464B and HDS-V3232, a SWITCHING FIELD which switch signals from the control terminal can  
be set. The SWITCHING FIELD are set using menu item “Z” of the secondary station and any SWITCHING FIELD  
mode (ODD, EVEN, FIELD, ASYNC) can be selected.  
The signal switching timing depends on whether it is controlled by RS-422A or the S-BUS.  
The following shows the timing charts of RS-422A and S-BUS for each SWITCHING FIELD mode.  
. When SWITCHING FIELD “EVEN” is set  
RS-422A  
Switching Command Switching Executed  
S-BUS  
Switching Command Switching Executed  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Switching Command  
ODD EVEN  
Switching Executed  
ODD EVEN  
Switching Command  
Switching Executed  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
. When SWITCHING FIELD “ODD” is set  
RS-422A  
S-BUS  
Switching Executed  
Switching Command  
ODD  
Switching Executed  
Switching Command  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Switching Command  
ODD EVEN ODD  
Switching Executed  
EVEN ODD  
Switching Command  
Switching Executed  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4 Field 5  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
. When SWITCHING FIELD “FIELD” is set  
RS-422A  
S-BUS  
Switching Executed  
Switching Command  
ODD  
Switching Executed  
Switching Command  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Switching Command  
ODD EVEN  
Switching Executed  
ODD EVEN  
Switching Command  
Switching Executed  
ODD  
EVEN  
ODD  
EVEN  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4  
. When SWITCHING FIELD “ASYNC” is set  
The signals will be switched immediately after the switching command is received regardless of the control method and  
protocol used.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
5-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6  
Confirmation of function  
6-1. Outline  
After the hardware and software have been set up, it is necessary to check if the system is working  
properly before starting the operation.  
Each routing switcher is equipped with the self-diagnosis function to check the system connection and  
status of each unit. As soon as the power of the unit is supplied or the system is reset, this function begins  
operations which check internal conditions and connections automatically. When a fault is detected, this  
is immediately displayed via the following four methods.  
1. Status indicator  
2. System status screen (*)  
3. Error No. indicator  
4. LEDs on the boards  
Moreover, the test mode and ISR function are available to find out the detail of error and cause.  
This section outlines the checks performed when the system is started up, and describes error messages  
displayed on [2. System status screen] in detail.  
For details of [1. Status indicator], [3. Error No. indicator] and ISR function, refer to the operation manual  
or maintenance manual provided with the unit. For [4. LEDs on the boards] and [Test mode], refer to the  
maintenance manual.  
* : The error messages displayed in [2. System Status Screen] are valid only when the control terminal is connected to the primary  
station in the S-BUS control system.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-2. Function Check Format  
6-2. Function Check Format  
The contents of each function and the structure of the error displays are as follows.  
LED Display for Internal  
Information  
Test Mode Function  
Test mode is effective for finding the  
causes of the error and the faulty  
sections which have been detected by  
the self-diagnosis function. It checks  
LEDs,switches and signal circuit using  
a rotary switch on CPU board.  
LED displays the presence/absence of  
the signals and setting of the switches  
independently, irrespective of the self-  
diagnosis and test mode.  
LEDs on Board  
Error No. Indicator*1  
Function Check  
Error No. Indicator*1  
Status Indicator*1  
Contorl Terminal (System Status Screen)  
Error Information When  
Error Messages  
Power ON  
Status Display *1  
Error Codes*1  
Self-diagnosis Function  
The self-diagnosis function of the routing switcher checks/judges hardware problem,  
disconnected wires, the conditon of the sync signal, the execution of the backup function,  
the communication errors,etc.  
*1 : HDS-V3232 does not have run diagnostics check on Status indicator and Error No. indicator.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-3. How the Self-Diagnosis Items are Related  
6-3. How the Self-Diagnosis Items are Related  
Status Indicator *1  
Error No. Indicator*1  
Control Terminal Display  
Lit in Green:  
00 Operating normally  
Operating Normally  
Blinking in Green:  
Faulty sync signal detection  
Faulty sync signal detection  
Faulty crosspoint hardware  
6 * Faulty sync signal detection  
Blinking in Red:  
Faulty crosspoint  
hardware  
4 * Faulty crosspoint hardware  
7 * Increase in the switcher's  
internal temperature/Fan has  
stopped  
Increase in the switcher's internal  
temperature/Fan has stopped  
Increase in the switcher's  
internal temperature/Fan  
has stopped  
2 * Communication error of the  
REMOTE 1 connector (BNC)  
/S-BUS  
S-BUS deta link has  
disconnected  
S-BUS deta link has been disconnected  
Communication trouble of the  
primary statiom  
Other errors  
Communication error with a  
secondary station  
8 * ROM/RAM/EEPROM check  
ROM/RAM/EEPROM check error  
Re-start display  
error or table deta reading error  
1 * Communication error of the  
REMOTE 2 connector (9-pin)  
/RS-422A  
Display of the input/output board  
insertion  
3 * Communication error of the  
REMOTE 3 connector (25-pin)  
/RS-232C  
5 * Incorrect setting data of the  
backup memory  
Start-up of backup power supply  
Start-up of backup CPU board  
Lit in Red:  
Start-up of backup unit  
FF Malfunction of CPU board  
*1 : HDS-V3232 does not have run diagnostics check on Status indicator and Error No. indicator.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-4. Diagnosis Items for Each Model  
6-4. Diagnosis Items for Each Model  
Self-diagnosis Items  
Error Display  
Model  
*1Status  
Status  
*1Error No. DVS-V1616 DVS-V3232B DVS-A3232 DVS-R1616  
Indicator  
display  
Indicator  
DVS-V6464B  
HDS-V3232  
DVS-TC3232  
BVS-V323  
BVS-A3232  
Checking normal operations  
Detecting sync signals  
Detecting the sync signals  
of the timing generator  
Sync signal lock function  
of the timing generator  
OK/NG of crosspoint  
hardware  
O
O
_
_
O
O
O
O
O
_
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
O
_
O
_
_
_
O
O
O
O
_
_
_
O
O
O
O
_
_
O
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
_
Unit’s internal temperature/  
Fan’s driving condition  
Detecting disconnection in  
the S-BUS data link  
Communicating condition with  
Secondary stations  
ROM/RAM/EEPROM check  
Re-start display  
_
_
_
O
O
O
O
_
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O*2  
Display of input/output  
board insertion  
_
Display of input/output  
board no-insertion  
_
_
_
O
_
_
O
O
O
O*2  
_
O
O
O
O
O
O
Communicating condition  
of REMOTE2/RS-422A  
Communicating condition  
of REMOTE3/RS-232C  
Backup memory setting data  
Set-up of backup power  
supply  
O
O
_
_
_
_
O
_
O
_
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Start-up back-up CPU board  
CPU board operations  
Timer stop  
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
O
_
_
_
_
O
O
O
O
O
_
O
O
_
*1 : HDS-V3232 does not have run diagnostics check on Status indicator and Error No. indicator.  
*2 : HDS-V3232 is valid only when has been not inserted the input/output board, when input/output board insertion/no-  
insertion will be displayed.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-5. Function Check Process  
6-5. Function Check Process  
After installing the hardware and software of the routing switcher system, check its functions and those of  
each device according to the following procedures. The process of the function check consists of three  
steps. The checks in step 2 and onward will be performed only when errors have been detected in step 1.  
If not, the checking process ends there. When errors have been displayed in step 1, except the cases that  
causes are found with the display contents, it is necessary to find out the faulty sections and causes by  
performing the checks from step 2. Countermeasures and the methods of fixing the errors are described in  
detail in the operation manuals and maintenance manuals provided. For the counter-measures and reme-  
dies, refer to the operation manual or the maintenance manual supplied with the unit.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Turn on the power of the S-BUS data link unit  
Check the status indicator  
STEP1  
Normal  
Check the system status screen  
Check the menu screen  
STEP2  
Open the front panel  
Check the LED displays  
on the board  
Counter-  
measures  
Check the error code  
(As repuired)  
STEP3  
Execute the test mode  
Completion of function check  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-6. Function Check with Control Terminal  
6-6. Function Check with Control Terminal  
There are two types of display modes for operation check from control terminal, which can be selected  
depending upon the purpose. The first type of display mode is provided by the system status display and  
the other is provided by the “W” menu on the menu display.  
The system status display shows result of self diagnostics that is performed automatically by the primary  
station when the main power of the system is turned on. It also shows error messages that are issued by  
the respective stations on the S-BUS data link in real time, enabling to use the system status display as the  
monitor of system operation during system run.  
To check the old system status, call the menu item [W: SYSTEM STATUS LOG].  
This menu takes out only the system status from the memory, and displays error messages, corresponding  
station and time of occurrence.  
n
As the control terminal constantly checks the errors of the system, and is capable of recording/displaying  
these, it is extremely effective for monitoring the operations of the system. Therefore, it is recommended  
to connect this control terminal after completing initial settings.  
6-6-1. System status screen after power on  
When the power of the primary station is turned on, the results of the self-diagnosis of the primary station  
and the ROM checksum value, will be displayed as shown in the figure below.  
If the result of the self-diagnosis is normal, “OK” will be displayed for this item. If errors have been  
detected, the corresponding item will be the reversal characters.  
SONY Digital Routing System DVS-V6464B V2.10  
ITEM  
ROM CHECK SUM  
8A65  
OK  
1
2
3
4
5
RAM READ AND WRITE  
REFERENCE SIGNAL  
S-BUS LINK TERMINATE  
REAL TIME CLOCK  
OK  
OK  
STARTED  
1993.02.03-22.15 STARTED BY DVS-V6464B Ver2.10 IN STATION 1  
1993.02.03-22.15 S-BUS LINK DISCONNECTED TO CHANNEL B  
1993.02.03-22.15 MISSING REFERENCE SIGNAL IN STATION 1  
1993.02.03-22.15 POWER SUPPLY UNIT B DOWN IN STATION 1  
Example of the System Status Screen After Power On  
Display Contents:  
1 ROM checksum value on the CPU board of the primary station.  
2 Condition of the reading/writing operations of the RAM in the primary station.  
3 The result of detecting the reference signal in the primary station.  
4 Presence of the 75 Z termination in the S-BUS data link.  
5 Oscillation of the real time clock IC.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-6. Function Check with Control Terminal  
6-6-2. System status screen during the system operation  
When a message is output to the S-BUS data link, the system status screen will display this message with  
the date and time of occurrence. When an error occurs during the operation of the system, the error  
message will be displayed.  
1990.10.12-15:42 S-BUS LINK DISCONNECTED  
Error message  
1990.10.27-09:28 STARTED BY BKS-R1601 Ver3.10 IN STATION 11  
1990.11.03-05:31 STARTED BY BKS-R3204 Ver3.11 IN STATION 32  
1991.01.14-13:51 MISSING REFERENCE SIGNAL IN STATION 1  
Error message  
1991.02.01-11:15 POWER SUPPLY UNIT B DOWN IN STATION 4  
1991.02.04-06:11 X-POINT ERROR IN STATION 1  
Example of System Status Screen During System Operation  
6-6-3. Menu item [W: SYSTEM STATUS LOG]  
On the other hand, the menu item [W: SYSTEM STATUS LOG] can be used to call all the error informa-  
tion stored in the RAM of the primary station, such as the content and time of errors in each station and  
on the S-BUS circuit.  
Operating procedure:  
1. Turn on the power supply of the primary station to automatically start up the system status screen.  
2. Press [Ctrl] _ [X] to display the menu screen.  
The password will be requested if it has been set. Input the password using the numerical and alpha-  
bet keys, and press [Return] or [Enter] .  
3. Select the menu item [W].  
4. “__ more __” will be displayed at the bottom of the screen if all error contents cannot be displayed  
on a screen.  
Press [SPACE] to display the next error content. “__ end __” will be displayed when all error  
contents have been displayed.  
5. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen.  
6. Press [Ctrl] _ [X] to return to the system status screen.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-6. Function Check with Control Terminal  
6-6-4. Contents and countermeasures of the error messages  
The control terminal will display eleven types of error messages according to the error content.  
However, depending on the model, some are not used because of no detection, or some part of the  
message may differ. For details of the messages and their countermeasures, refer to operation manuals  
provided with each model.  
Standard error messages and their countermeasures are as follows.  
X-POINT ERROR IN STATION * * *  
Content :  
Faulty crosspoint hardware  
As a result of comparing the presence/absence of the crosspoint signal in the station  
being displayed, this message will be displayed if the input signal was found to be  
present without the output signal, and vice versa, or if the input/output board has not  
been inserted correctly.  
Countermeasure : The crosspoint of station * * * is faulty. Check the input/output board has been  
properly installed.  
TEMPERATURE RISE OR FAN STOP IN STATION * * *  
Content :  
This message is displayed when the temperature inside of the station being displayed  
has risen, or when the fan has stopped.  
Countermeasure : Promptly turn off the power supply of station * * *, and check for short-circuits,  
power leakage, faults of the mechanical parts surrounding the fan, etc.  
MISSING REFERENCE SIGNAL IN STATION * * *  
Content :  
This message is displayed when the SYNC/ASYNC select switch on the CPU board of  
the switcher has been set to the sync switching mode (SYNC), and the reference video  
signal has not been input to the REF IN connector.  
Countermeasure : Connect the sync signal to the REF IN connector of station * * *.  
n
Set the SYNC/ASYNC select switch to “ASYNC” if the reference signal is not present. When the  
reference signal is not input in the sync switching mode (SYNC), the crosspoint is switched automatically  
as the async switching mode (ASYNC).  
CHANGED OVER TO BACKUP POWER SUPPLY IN STATION * * *  
Content :  
This message is displayed when the power supply output during operations has  
dropped and it is changed over to the backup power supply.  
Countermeasure : Remove the faulty power supply of station * * *, and repair or replace it with a new  
one.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-6. Function Check with Control Terminal  
DIFFERENT CHECK SUM= ???? IN STATION  
*
*
*
Check sun value  
Content :  
This message is displayed when an error has been detected as the result of ROM  
checksum and RAM writing tests performed after resetting the unit.  
Countermeasure : Replace the corresponding ROM.  
n
This error message will be displayed even after the ROM has been replaced. This is normal. Execute the  
menu item [J: RECALL MAIN TABLE] from the control terminal, and reset the corresponding unit once  
again for the unit to begin operating normally.  
S-BUS LINK DISCONNECTED  
Content :  
This message is displayed when the S-BUS data link has been disconnected some-  
where.  
Countermeasure : Check the connections between the S-BUS line and each station, and check that unused  
S-BUS ports or the ends of S-BUS lines have been terminated with 75 Z. One method  
to search for the disconnected sections is using the menu item [R: CALL SECOND-  
ARY STATION] and checking for responses.  
n
Be sure to terminate unused S-BUS ports with 75 Z. When a disconnection has been detected, the  
primary station automatically performs 75 Z termination and restarts communication with the stations  
just before the disconnection. In this case, some stations may not be able to communicate even though  
they are connected.  
CHANGED OVER TO BACKUP CPU IN STATION * * *  
Content :  
This message is displayed when an error has occurred in the CPU board during opera-  
tions, and it is changed over to the backup CPU board.  
Countermeasure : Remove the main CPU board, and repair or replace it with a new one.  
STARTED BY * * * _ * * * * * Ver *.* * IN STATION * * *  
Content :  
This message is displayed when the switcher is restarted due to instantaneous power  
failure, etc., or when the power supply is turned ON.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-6. Function Check with Control Terminal  
STATION * * * FAILURE(DISCONNECTED OR POWER DOWN)  
Content :  
This message is displayed when communication with the station set at the menu item  
[F] is stopped.  
Countermeasure : Check the status indicator of station * * *, and perform the adjustment corresponding  
to the symptom.  
VALID INPUT OR OUTPUT BOARD IN STATION * * *  
Content :  
Content :  
This message is displayed when the input/output board has been inserted to station * * *.  
INVALID INPUT OR OUTPUT BOARD IN STATION * * *  
This message is displayed when the input/output board has been removed from * * *.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7  
Change Information on DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series  
and DVS-V3232M/V6464M  
7-1. Outline (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)  
The S-BUS protocol is extended of its virtual matrix size from 512 to 1024.  
At the same time the following functions are changed.  
. Number of SOURCE/DEST TYPEs is extended from 16 to 32.  
. Selection of either 1024 x 1024 x 8 level or 1024 x 512 x 16 level is added.  
. Number of the GLOBAL PHANTOM is reduced from 4093 to 2800.  
. The multi source assignment function is added.  
. Number of DESCRIPTION NAME is extended from 1024 to 2048.  
. Number of the Tie Line signals is increased from 4 to 255.  
In the following description, the product that supports the virtual matrix size 512 is called the S-BUS P1  
type, and the product that supports the virtual matrix size 1024 is called the S-BUS P2 type.  
The S-P2 has the higher compatibility with the S-P1 but has the several limitations.  
The S-P2 is realized by extending the type number of the terminal name from 16 to 32, and by changing  
the data structure of the terminal names. The 16 types of the terminal number data that are used in the S-  
P1, do not have compatibility with the 32 types of terminal number data that are used in the S-P2. There-  
fore, the S-P2 has two types of data i.e., both the 16 type data and the 32 type data for each terminal of  
terminal number 1 to 512. The 16 type data needs to be used for the terminal numbers of 1 to 512 when  
the S-P1 UMD and the remote control panel are used in the system. The 32 type data needs to be used for  
the terminal numbers of 513 to 1024.  
When all of the UMD and the remote control panel within the system is of the S-P2 type, the terminal  
numbers of 1 to 512 must be set to the 32 type data.  
When use of the remote control panels of the S-P1 and S-P2 types are mixed, use of the S-P1 remote  
control panel is limited within the range of terminal numbers from 1 to 512. In such a case, the S-P2  
remote control panel can handle the 32 type data with the terminal numbers of 513 to 1024.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2. Changed Menu (Primary Station Setting Items)  
7-2. Changed Menu (Primary Station Setting Items)  
n
The menu screen shown below is based on the DVS-128.  
Initial screen (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)  
When the [Ctrl] _ [X] key is pressed after the main power is turned on, the following display appears.  
SONY ROUTING SYSTEM SETUP MENU  
DVS-128 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
MODIFICATION COMMAND  
A: DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
C: SET DESTINATION NAME  
E: SET LEVEL TABLE  
B: SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE  
D: SET SOURCE NAME  
F: SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
H: SET GLOBAL PHANTOM  
G: UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
J: NAME STYLE(Type + Num)  
M: SET INHIBIT TABLE  
L: SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT  
N: SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP  
Q: CHANGE CROSSPOINT  
O: SET TIE LINES  
R: CALL SECONDARY STATION  
S: SET SOURCE ASSIGNMENT  
MAINTENANCE COMMAND  
P: CHANGE PASSWORD  
T: SET CLOCK  
U: SELECT CONTROL MODE  
X: DISPLAY S-BUS COMMUNICATION  
W: SYSTEM STATUS LOG  
Z: SET UNIT DETECTABLE  
Ctrl-X/B:QUIT SETUP MENU  
Example of Initial Screen  
Changed item  
. [K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE] is deleted from the primary station screen and is moved to the  
secondary station screen.  
When [K: RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE] is executed on the secondary station screen, the partial  
initialization is executed in the S-P1, but is changed so that all data including the works is reset to the  
default data when shipped from the factory.  
. [S: SET SOURCE ASSIGNMENT] is newly added.  
. The [Ctrl] _ [B] key is added as the key input to return to the initial menu (the screen when the main  
power is turned on.) The [Ctrl] _ [B] key has the same function as the [Ctrl] _ [X].  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2. Changed Menu (Primary Station Setting Items)  
A : DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
(DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)  
B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE  
(DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)  
Purpose  
Purpose  
This menu displays the control size as the primary station.  
This menu is used to set the type name of the source  
destination and global phantom table.  
The menu makes the management of source/destination  
easier.  
DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
SOURCE No 0001-1024  
DVS-128 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
DESTINATION No 0001-1024 LEVEL 1-8  
The alphanumeric characters of 4 characters or less can be  
used. Either 16 type data or the 32 type data can be  
selected for the terminal numbers of 1 to 512.  
SOURCE/DEST/PHANTOM TYPE  
DVS-128 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
TYPE:32  
0=IN  
1=OUT  
2=....  
A=....  
I=....  
Q=....  
3=....  
B=....  
J=....  
R=....  
4=....  
C=....  
K=....  
S=....  
5=....  
D=....  
L=....  
T=....  
6=....  
E=....  
M=....  
U=....  
7=....  
F=....  
N=....  
V=....  
8=....  
G=....  
O=....  
9=....  
H=....  
P=....  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Display Screen  
When LEVEL: 1 to 16 on the [E: SET LEVEL TABLE]  
screen is set to 1, the message [SOURCE No. 0001-1024  
DESTINATION No. 0001-0512 LEVEL 1-16] appears.  
There are no input items or set items on this screen.  
F1:TYPE  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
. Every pressing of [F1:TYPE] triggers between TYPE:  
16 and TYPE: 32. Either one of the data structures of  
the terminal name to be handed by the S-P1, is selected.  
. When [F1] is pressed, the message [Do you change the  
type number? Y or N] appears. When either [Y] or [N]  
is pressed, change the setting of the type number.  
The terminal name from 1 to 512  
. TYPE : 16 The names up to 16 types can be used.  
When the S-P1 type remote control panel  
or the UMD is used in the system, select  
the TYPE 16.  
. TYPE : 32 The names up to 32 types can be used.  
When the S-P1 type remote control panel  
or the UMD is used in the system, the  
correct display or correct operation  
cannot be performed.  
The terminal names of No. 513 to 1024 are fixed to type  
32 without affected by this setting.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2. Changed Menu (Primary Station Setting Items)  
E : SET LEVEL TABLE  
O : SET TIE LINES (DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)  
(DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)  
Purpose  
Purpose  
Change/addition/deletion of the TIE LINE data are per-  
formed here.  
The level name can be set, and the valid level for each  
output terminal can be set.  
Number of levels of either 8 or 16 can also be selected.  
SET TIE LINES  
DVS-128 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
--PATHS 1------------------------------------------------------------------  
SOURCE: SOURCE No.  
DESTINETION No.  
ROUTE:  
SOURCE No.  
0081 - 0082 0080 - 0086  
DESTINETION No.  
0083 - 0089 0100 - 0130  
--PATHS 2------------------------------------------------------------------  
DESTINETION No.  
LEVEL TABLE  
DVS-128 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 1  
L1 0001 - 0080 0001 - 0004  
L2  
LEVEL:1-16  
DESTINATION:SOURCE No.  
L1  
1=VIT  
2=A1  
3=A2  
4=TC  
5=REM  
6=B32 7=.... 8=....  
9=.... 10=.... 11=.... 12=.... 13=.... 14=.... 15=.... 16=....  
No. out  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
VIT  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A1  
A2  
TC  
REM  
....  
....  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
REM  
B32  
....  
....  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
B32  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
....  
SOURCE: SOURCE No. DESTINETION No.  
ROUTE:  
SOURCE No.  
.... - .... .... - ....  
DESTINETION No.  
0200 - 0201 0300 - 0400  
--PATHS 3------------------------------------------------------------------  
DESTINETION No.  
0001 OUT001  
0002 OUT002  
0003 OUT003  
0004 OUT004  
0005 OUT005  
0006 OUT006  
0007 OUT007  
0008 OUT008  
0009 OUT009  
0010 OUT010  
0011 OUT011  
0012 OUT012  
0013 OUT013  
0014 OUT014  
0015 OUT015  
0016 OUT016  
0017 OUT017  
....  
....  
A2  
....  
....  
TC  
L2 0001 - 0040 0005 - 0006  
L.  
DESTINATION:SOURCE No.  
L1  
A2  
TC  
A2  
TC  
SOURCE: SOURCE No.  
DESTINETION No.  
ROUTE:  
SOURCE No.  
.... - .... .... - ....  
DESTINETION No.  
.... - .... .... - ....  
--PATHS 4------------------------------------------------------------------  
DESTINETION No.  
A2  
TC  
L. .... - .... .... - ....  
L.  
A2  
TC  
DESTINATION:SOURCE No.  
L.  
A2  
TC  
A2  
TC  
A2  
TC  
SOURCE: SOURCE No.  
DESTINETION No.  
ROUTE:  
L.  
SOURCE No.  
DESTINETION No.  
A2  
TC  
L.  
.... - .... .... - ....  
.... - .... .... - ....  
A2  
TC  
DESTINATION:SOURCE No.  
L.  
DESTINETION No.  
A2  
TC  
.... - .... .... - ....  
A2  
TC  
A2  
TC  
F1:PgUp F2:PgDn  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
A2  
TC  
A2  
TC  
Example of Setting Screen  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F3:LEVEL  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
To set the number, press [Enter] to be ready for number  
input. Enter a number in the range of 1 to 1024. When  
[Enter] is pressed again, the number is set, the range is  
checked and duplication of the same number with other  
setting is checked. Then the number is set.  
Example of Setting Screen  
Every pressing of [F3:LEVEL] toggles between the  
LEVEL: 1-8 display and the LEVEL: 1-16 display on the  
2 nd line.  
The LEVEL 9-16 is realized by switching the Destination  
to which 512 is added, at the same time.  
When the system is used with the LEVEL 1-16, the remote  
control panel that supports the LEVEL 1-16 becomes  
necessary.  
If duplication of the number is found, the entered number  
becomes invalid and the former number remains as it is.  
To delete a terminal number, press [Enter] without  
inputting a numbers. Then “....” appears and the terminal  
number is deleted.  
Number of the signals to be set is 254 at the maximum.  
Number of the TIE LINEs to be set is 16 paths at the  
maximum.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2. Changed Menu (Primary Station Setting Items)  
(Example)  
An example in which the three matrices of 10 x 10 are used and are connected by the Tie-Line, is shown.  
A signal of IN 1-10 and IN 13-20 can be selected from OUT 21-30 in this example.  
SET TIE LINES  
DVS-128 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
--PATHS 1------------------------------------------------------------------  
SOURCE: SOURCE No.  
DESTINETION No.  
ROUTE:  
SOURCE No.  
0011 - 0012 0017 - 0018  
DESTINETION No.  
0021 - 0022 0021 - 0030  
--PATHS 2------------------------------------------------------------------  
DESTINETION No.  
L1 0001 - 0010 0009 - 0010  
L2  
DESTINATION:SOURCE No.  
L1  
SOURCE: SOURCE No.  
DESTINETION No.  
ROUTE:  
L.  
SOURCE No.  
DESTINETION No.  
L2 0013 - 0020 0019 - 0020  
.... - .... .... - ....  
DESTINATION:SOURCE No.  
L1  
DESTINETION No.  
0023 - 0024 0021 - 0030  
Example of Setting Screen  
1
1
10  
~
10  
1
1
13  
20  
~
10 x 10  
8
8
9
10  
LEVEL 1  
20  
11  
12 11 13  
11  
16  
25  
31  
16  
10 x 10  
17  
18  
19  
20  
LEVEL 2  
24 23 22 21 25  
31  
21  
21  
10 x 10  
30  
30  
LEVEL 1  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2. Changed Menu (Primary Station Setting Items)  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
7-3. Changed Menu  
(Secondary Station Setting Items)  
S : SET SOURCE ASSIGNMENT  
(DVS-128/HDS-X3000 Series)  
Purpose  
N : SET PANEL TABLE (HDS-X3400)  
Change/addition/deletion of the MULTIPLE SOURCE  
name are performed here. When the signal name that has  
been set as level 1 from the remote control, is supposed to  
be named as TAKE, the signals whose source numbers are  
set here, can be selected in the level 2 and later.  
Purpose  
This menu is used to set the switch of the BKS-R3400  
(panel switch).  
Setting procedure  
1. Select the menu item “N”.  
SET SOURCE ASSIGNMENT  
DVS-128 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 1  
VID  
A-A1  
IN001  
IN002  
IN002  
IN002  
IN005  
IN006  
M1  
A-A2  
A3  
A4  
REM  
TBC  
SAPS  
2. Select the desired button number using the cursor.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the machine enters the channel  
number input mode. The input mode is canceled if [Enter]  
is pressed before inputting the channel number in step 4.  
4. Input the channel number of 1 to 16 from the keyboard.  
The input channel is input by entering a number to the table  
of the SOURCE side, and the output channel is input by  
entering a number to the table of the DESTINATION side.  
5. Press [Enter] to set the input setting.  
0001 IN001  
0002 IN002  
0003 IN003  
0004 IN004  
0005 IN005  
0006 IN006  
0007 C1  
IN001  
IN002  
IN002  
IN002  
IN005  
IN006  
IN001  
IN002  
IN002  
IN002  
IN005  
IN006  
IN001  
IN002  
IN002  
IN002  
IN005  
IN006  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
IN004  
IN005  
IN006  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
IN004  
IN005  
IN006  
IN001  
IN002  
IN003  
IN004  
IN005  
IN006  
....... ....... ....... ....... ....... .......  
....... ....... ....... ....... ....... .......  
....... ....... ....... ....... ....... .......  
....... ....... ....... ....... ....... .......  
....... ....... ....... ....... ....... .......  
0008 C2  
M1  
0009 C3  
M2  
0010 C4  
M3  
0011 C5  
M1  
0012 IN012  
0013 IN013  
0014 IN014  
0015 IN015  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
IN012  
IN013  
IN014  
IN015  
6. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
0=IN  
8=CG  
G=17  
O=25  
1=OUT  
9=SAT  
2=VTR  
3=ENG  
4=MCR  
5=TEST  
D=GPHA  
L=22  
6=SNG  
E=GPHB  
M=23  
7=SS  
A=LMS  
I=19  
Q=27  
B=EDIT  
J=20  
C=CAM  
K=21  
S=29  
F=GPHC  
N=24  
H=18  
P=26  
R=28  
T=30  
U=31  
V=32  
SET PANEL TABLE  
HDS-X3400 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 1  
F1:SEARCH F2:JUMP F3:PgUp F4:PgDn  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
SET PANEL TABLE(SOURCE)  
01 KEY=001  
02 KEY=002  
03 KEY=003  
04 KEY=004  
Example of Setting Screen  
06 KEY=006  
07 KEY=007  
08 KEY=008  
05 KEY=005  
10 KEY=010  
11 KEY=011  
12 KEY=012  
09 KEY=009  
14 KEY=014  
15 KEY=015  
16 KEY=016  
13 KEY=013  
The SOURCE name of LEVEL 1 is fixed in the same way  
as the source name setting. The SOURCE names of the  
LEVEL-2 to 8 are set using this screen.  
18 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
22 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
26 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
30 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
19 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
23 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
27 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
31 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
20 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
24 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
28 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
32 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
17 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
21 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
25 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
29 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
Set the name by entering the Type number first then by  
entering the successive three digit number. This name can  
be deleted using [Ctrl] _ [P]. If an illegal name is set, a  
message [The name is not defined] appears, the original  
name is resumed. When a valid SOURCE name has  
already been input, the name is set, the correspond  
SOURCE number is internally saved and the cursor moves  
to the next position.  
SET PANEL TABLE(DESTINATION)  
02 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
03 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
07 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
11 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
15 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
19 KEY=003  
04 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
08 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
12 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
16 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
20 KEY=004  
01 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
05 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
09 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
13 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
17 KEY=001  
06 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
10 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
14 KEY=· · · · · · ·  
18 KEY=002  
22 KEY=006  
23 KEY=007  
24 KEY=008  
21 KEY=005  
26 KEY=010  
27 KEY=011  
28 KEY=012  
25 KEY=009  
30 KEY=014  
31 KEY=015  
32 KEY=016  
29 KEY=013  
3
LED BRIGHTNESS LEVEL(1-8)  
F1:TABLE F2:LED  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
When “Enter” is pressed without entering name, “....”  
appears and the setting is deleted.  
Example of Setting Screen  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
V : DISPLAY UNIT STATUS (DVS-128)  
Purpose  
Purpose is to display the internal status of the equipment.  
There are no setting on this screen.  
Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
Operating Function Keys  
[F1] : TABLE (Mode which assigns source and destina-  
tion to the buttons)  
DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
DVS-128 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 1  
This setting is valid for local input/output physical ter-  
minals of the HDS-X3400. The SOURCE and DESTI-  
NATION of other unit cannot be set from this button.  
[F2] : LED (Mode which adjusts brightness of the button.)  
1. Press [F2]. The cursor moves to [LED  
BRIGHTNESS LEVEL (1-8)] on the screen.  
2. Press any key of 1 to 8 from the keyboard.  
Brightness of the buttons will change accord-  
ingly. (dark 1 8 bright)  
INPUT BOARD  
01-32  
MAIN  
CONNECTOR  
VALID  
STYLE  
REFERENCE  
VALID  
Analog Video  
Analog Audio  
Digital Audio  
------------  
A
B
B
-
33-64  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
65-96  
97-128  
OUTPUT BOARD  
01-32  
MAIN  
CONNECTOR  
VALID  
STYLE  
REFERENCE  
VALID  
Analog Video  
Analog Audio  
Digital Audio  
------------  
A
B
B
-
33-64  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
INVALID  
65-96  
97-128  
A
B
CONTROL BOARD  
REFERENCE SIGNAL  
SELECT FIELD  
525  
625  
MAIN S-BUS MONITOR  
V1.00 V1.00 V1.00  
INVALID  
FIELD  
ON  
ODD  
n
M
B
POWER SUPPLIES  
INVALID  
The BKS-R3400 directly controls only the connected  
HDS-X3400 regardless of the setting of the primary  
station, that is different from other remote control units.  
FAN1 FAN2 FAN3  
ROT  
ROT  
ROT  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Display Screen  
Description of contents on display  
MAIN or CONNECTOR : VALID/INVALID  
Displays whether the board (MAIN) to be inserted from  
the front and the rear connector board, are inserted or not.  
STYLE : Analog Video/Analog Audio/Digital Audio  
Displays the name of the optional signals that are inserted  
to each option slot.  
REFERENCE : A/B  
Displays which of the two types of the reference signal, is  
selected.  
REFERENCE SIGNAL : 525/625  
Displays the number of lines of the detected reference  
signal.  
SELECT FIELD : ASYNC/ODD/EVEN/FIELD  
Displays the switching timing of matrix.  
POWER SUPPLIES : ON/INVALID  
Displays whether the power supply unit is inserted or not.  
FANx : ROT/STOP  
Displays whether the rear panel fan is rotating or not.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
V : DISPLAY UNIT STATUS (HDS-X3000 Series)  
Purpose  
Purpose is to display the internal status of the equipment.  
There are no setting on this screen.  
Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to return to the menu screen of the  
secondary station.  
DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
HDS-X3400 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 1  
DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
HDS-X3700 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 1  
MAIN  
REV  
CN 01-16  
HD SDI  
REV  
1.0  
P.S  
OK  
MAIN  
REV CN01-16 REV CN17-32 REV P.S  
INPUT  
01-16  
INPUT  
01-32  
33-64  
65-96  
97-128  
HD SDI 1.0  
HD SDI  
HD SDI  
HD SDI  
INVALID  
1.0 HD SDI  
1.0 HD SDI  
1.0 OK  
1.0 OK  
1.0 OK  
1.0 HD 0pt16 1.0 HD SDI  
1.0 SD SDI  
INVALID  
1.0 SD SDI  
INVALID  
MAIN  
REV  
CN 01-16  
HD SDI  
REV  
1.0  
P.S  
OK  
OUTPUT  
01-32  
33-64  
65-96  
97-128  
OUTPUT  
01-16  
MAIN  
REV CN01-16 REV CN17-32 REV P.S REF FANA FANB  
HD SDI 1.0  
HD SDI  
HD SDI  
HD SDI  
INVALID  
1.0 HD SDI  
1.0 HD SDI 1.0 OK  
A
B
A
ROT ROT  
ROT ROT  
ROT ROT  
ROT ROT  
1.0 HD 0pt16 1.0 HD SDI 1.0 OK  
1.0 SD SDI  
INVALID  
1.0 SD SDI 1.0 OK  
INVALID  
FRONT PANEL BKS-R3400  
A
B
CONTROL BOARD  
MAIN S-BUS  
V1.00 V1.00  
REFERENCE SIGNAL  
SELECT FIELD  
1125p  
FIELD  
ON  
CONTROL BOARD  
MAIN S-BUS MONITOR  
V1.00 V1.00 V1.00  
INVALID  
REFERENCE SIGNAL  
SELECT FIELD  
1125p 625  
FIELD ODD  
POWER SUPPLIES  
M
B
POWER SUPPLIES  
ON  
INVALID  
FAN1 FAN2  
FAN1 FAN2 FAN3 FAN4 FAN5 FAN6  
ROT ROT ROT ROT ROT ROT  
ROT  
ROT  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Display Screen (HDS-X3700)  
Example of Display Screen (HDS-X3400)  
Description of contents on display  
MAIN or CN01-16/CN17-32: HD SDI/SD SDI/HD 0pt8/  
INVALID  
Displays whether the board (MAIN) to be inserted from  
the front and the rear connector board (CN01-16/CN17-  
32), are inserted or not.  
DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
HDS-X3600 V1.00  
STATION NUMBER 1  
MAIN  
HD SDI 1.0 HD SDI  
HD SDI 1.0 HD 0pt16 1.0 HD SDI  
REV CN01-16 REV CN17-32  
REV P.S  
INPUT  
01-32  
33-64  
1.0 HD SDI  
1.0 OK  
1.0 OK  
OUTPUT  
01-32  
33-64  
MAIN  
HD SDI 1.0 HD SDI  
HD SDI 1.0 HD 0pt16 1.0 HD SDI  
REV CN01-16 REV CN17-32  
REV P.S REF FANA FANB  
1.0 HD SDI  
1.0 OK  
1.0 OK  
A
B
ROT ROT  
ROT ROT  
P.S : OK/NG  
Displays the power supply status of the MAIN and two CN boards.  
A
B
CONTROL BOARD  
MAIN S-BUS MONITOR  
REFERENCE SIGNAL  
1125p 625  
FIELD ODD  
REV : REVISION of the boards  
SELECT FIELD  
M
B
V1.00 V1.00 V1.00  
INVALID  
POWER SUPPLIES  
ON  
INVALID  
REF : A/B  
FAN1 FAN2  
ROT  
ROT  
Displays which of the two types of the reference signal is selected.  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
REFERENCE SIGNAL : 525i/625i/1125i  
Displays the number of lines of the detected reference signal.  
Example of Display Screen (HDS-X3600)  
SELECT FIELD : ASYNC/ODD/EVEN/FIELD/(ASYNC)  
Displays the switching timing of the matrix.  
POWER SUPPLIEDS : ON/INVALID/OVERLOAD  
Displays the status of the power supply unit. When  
OVERLOAD is displayed as this status, it means that the  
excess number of rear optical connectors more than the  
specified number are installed.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
Z : SET SDI FORMAT (HDS-X3000 Series)  
FANA, FANB : ROT/STOP  
Purpose  
Displays whether the fan on the matrix board is rotating or  
not.  
This menu is used to set the signal format for the output  
board of the HDS-X3000 series (whether the signal is  
reclocked in the HD-SDI or not) from the control terminal.  
This setting becomes valid when the dip switch of the  
RECLOCK BYPASS of the output board is turned off.  
When the processor unit of HDS-X3000 series has the SD-  
SDI output board (HKDS-X3050), the setting of the format  
is not required.  
FANn : ROT/STOP  
Displays whether the fan of the main unit (except the  
power supply unit) is rotating or not.  
FRONT PANEL : BKS-R3400/INVALID  
Displays whether the option switch is attached to the front  
of the HDS-X3400 or not.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select the menu item “Z”.  
n
2. Select the desired channel line using the cursor to be  
set. (The HDS-X3400 will be switched in every four  
channels, and the HDS-X3600/X3700 will be switched  
in every eight channels.)  
If the board (MAIN) to be inserted from the front is not  
installed, the status of the rear connector board is not  
displayed correctly.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the setting changes (“HD  
SDI (RC)” “HD SDI (RC PASS)”).  
4. Press [S] (Table Set), and the content now on display  
is copied to the area of SDI FORMAT TABLE.  
n
Unless pressing [S] (Table Set), the data will be  
deleted when the power is turned off.  
5. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to stop the display and return to the  
menu screen of the secondary station.  
SELECT SDI FORMAT  
DESTINATION UNIT  
HDS-X3400 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE UNIT  
01 - 04 : HD SDI(RC)  
05 - 08 : HD SDI(RC)  
09 - 12 : HD SDI(RC)  
13 - 16 : HD SDI(RC)  
01 - 04 :  
05 - 08 :  
09 - 12 :  
13 - 16 :  
SWITCHING FIELD  
FIELD  
F1:FORMAT F2:FIELD S:Table Set  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen (HDS-X3400)  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
Operating Function Keys  
SELECT SDI FORMAT  
DESTINATION UNIT  
HDS-X3600 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
[F1] : FORMAT (Mode in which the HDS-X3400 is set in  
the units of the four channels and the HDS-X3600/  
X3700 is set in the units of the eight channels)  
SOURCE UNIT  
REFERENCE SELECT  
01 - 32 : A  
01 - 08 : HD SDI(RC)  
01 - 08 :  
09 - 16 :  
17 - 24 :  
25 - 32 :  
33 - 40 :  
41 - 48 :  
49 - 56 :  
57 - 64 :  
09 - 16 : HD SDI(RC)  
17 - 24 : HD SDI(RC)  
HD SDI (RC) :  
When the input signal is HD-  
SDI, the signal is reclocked  
and is output.)  
25 - 32 : HD SDI(RC)  
33 - 40 : HD SDI(RC PASS)  
41 - 48 : HD SDI(RC PASS)  
49 - 56 : HD SDI(RC PASS)  
57 - 64 : HD SDI(RC PASS)  
33 - 64 : A  
HD SDI (RC PASS) : The input signal is bypassed  
and is output as it is.  
SWITCHING FIELD  
A:FIELD B:ODD  
[F2] : FIELD (Mode which sets the crosspoint switching  
field)  
F1:FORMAT F2:FIELD F3:REFERE S:Table Set Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
1. Press [F2]. The cursor moves to “SWITCH-  
ING FIELD” on the screen.  
Example of Setting Screen (HDS-X3600)  
2. Move the cursor to ERF.A REF.B using the  
cursor key of the keyboard.  
3. Press [Enter]. The status changes as follows.  
(ODD EVEN FIELD ASYNC →  
ODD . . .)  
SELECT SDI FORMAT  
DESTINATION UNIT  
HDS-X3700 V1.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE UNIT  
REFERENCE SELECT  
01 - 32 : A  
01 - 08 : HD SDI(RC)  
09 - 16 : HD SDI(RC)  
17 - 24 : HD SDI(RC)  
25 - 32 : HD SDI(RC)  
33 - 40 : HD SDI(RC PASS) 33 - 40 :  
41 - 48 : HD SDI(RC PASS) 41 - 48 :  
01 - 08 :  
09 - 16 :  
17 - 24 :  
25 - 32 :  
33 - 64 : A  
49 - 56 :  
57 - 64 :  
65 - 72 :  
73 - 80 :  
81 - 88 :  
89 - 96 :  
97 - 104 :  
105 - 112 :  
113 - 120 :  
121 - 128 :  
49 - 56 :  
57 - 64 :  
65 - 72 :  
73 - 80 :  
81 - 88 :  
89 - 96 :  
97 - 104 :  
105 - 112 :  
113 - 120 :  
121 - 128 :  
65 - 96 : B  
97 - 128 : B  
[F3] : REFERE (Mode which selects the reference of the  
switching timing of the crosspoint in units of the  
output 32 channels)  
1. Press [F3]. The cursor moves to “REFER-  
ENCE SELECT” on the screen.  
SWITCHING FIELD  
A:FIELD  
B:ODD  
F1:FORMAT F2:FIELD F3:REFERE S:Table Set  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
2. Select a channel using the cursor of the key-  
board.  
3. Press [Enter]. The setting changes. (A B)  
Example of Setting Screen (HDS-X3700)  
n
When using both the CART protocol and S-BUS in RS-  
422A, set REFERENCE (switching timing) to A and  
SWITCHING FIELD to ODD. If other setting is per-  
formed, the switching timing is sometimes not executed  
correctly.  
In addition, the switching timing is sometimes not execut-  
ed correctly if SWITCHING FIELD is set in other combi-  
nations. For more details about the signal switching  
timings, refer to “5-8. Signal Switching Timing”.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
Z : SELECT SDI FORMAT  
(DVS-V3232M/DVS-V6464M)  
Purpose  
Operating Function Keys  
This menu is used to set the format of signals fed to the  
input/output board of DVS-V3232M and DVS-V6464M  
with the control terminal.  
This setting is available when the REM/LOC switch for the  
format on each input/output board is OFF.  
[F1] : FORMAT (Mode which sets the signal format by 8-  
channels)  
[F2] : FIELD (Mode which sets the crosspoint switching  
field)  
1. Press [F2]. The cursor will move to “SWITCH  
ING FIELD” in the menu.  
Setting Procedure  
1. Select menu item “Z”.  
2. Press [Enter]. The setting will change.  
(ODD EVEN FIELD ASYNC ODD···)  
All switching field in the switcher are deter  
mined by this setting.  
2. Select a channel line using the cursor to be set. (The  
channels will be switched by eight channels.  
Displayed signal formats that are enclosed by the  
round brackets as “(270 Mbps)” have been set on the  
board and cannot be modified with the control termi-  
nal.  
3. When [Enter] is pressed, the setting will change  
(“143 Mbps” “117 Mbps” “270 Mbps” →  
“AUTO”).  
When a display “(ASYNC)” appears on the  
screen, it indicates that the cross-point selector  
field has been set in the ASYNC (asynchro-  
nous) position on the CPU-149 board (S4-1). It  
means that the setting cannot be changed from  
the control terminal.  
4. Press [S] (Table Set), and the content now appeared is  
copied to the area of SDI FORMAT TABLE.  
5. Press [Ctrl] _ [E] to stop the display and return to the  
menu screen of the secondary station.  
n
To use RS-422A and S-BUS together, set the switching  
field as follows.  
1 When using the S-BUS and CART protocol together :  
ODD  
2 When using the S-BUS and PRODUCTION  
SWITCHER protocol together : FIELD  
SELECT SDI FORMAT  
DESTINATION UNIT  
DVS-V6464M V3.00 STATION NUMBER 1  
SOURCE UNIT  
01 - 08 : 270 Mbps  
09 - 16 : 143 Mbps  
17 - 24 : 270 Mbps  
25 - 32 : 143 Mbps  
33 - 40 : 360 Mbps  
41 - 48 : 540 Mbps  
49 - 56 :( 270 Mbps )  
57 - 64 : AUTO  
01 - 08 : 270 Mbps  
09 - 16 : 270 Mbps  
17 - 24 : 270 Mbps  
25 - 32 : 270 Mbps  
33 - 40 : 270 Mbps  
41 - 48 : 270 Mbps  
49 - 56 :( 270 Mbps )  
57 - 64 : 270 Mbps  
Note that the switching timing of the CART will not be  
accurate if the CART and PRODUCTION SWITCHERS  
protocols are used together.  
Switching timing is not guaranteed in the combination of  
different switching fields.  
SWITCHING FIELD  
FIELD  
For details of the signal switching timing, refer to “5-8.  
Signal Switching Timing”.  
F1:FORMAT F2:FIELD S:Table Set  
Ctrl-E:RETURN TO MENU  
Example of Setting Screen  
n
Unless pressing [S], the data will be deleted when the  
power is turned off.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
“AUTO” stands for “AUTO LOCK” mode in which the input signal format (143/177/270/360/540 Mbps)  
is automatically identified and the equipment runs on an appropriate signal format.  
The signal format setting can be changed by pressing either [Enter] or [F].  
[Enter]  
[F]  
or  
[Enter]  
[Enter]  
[Enter]  
[F]  
[Enter]  
143 Mbps  
177 Mbps  
270 Mbps  
AUTO  
360 Mbps  
540 Mbps  
[F]  
or  
[Enter]  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-3. Changed Menu (Secondary Station Setting Items)  
Comparison Table between Models  
Item  
S-P1  
S-P2  
BVS-V3232(*1) DVS-V6464B/  
V6464M(*2)  
BKPF-R70  
DVS-128(*3)  
BKPF-R70A  
Dedicated CPU for communication  
SOFT MATRIX  
_
1
2
1
2
_
_
64  
_
128  
A : DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE  
C : SET DESTINATION NAME  
D : SET SOURCE NAME  
512 x 512  
512 x 512  
512 x 512  
1024 x 1024 1024 x 1024  
16  
512  
512  
8
16  
16  
512  
512  
8
32  
32  
512  
1024  
1024  
16  
1024  
1024  
16  
512  
E : SET LEVEL TABLE  
8
F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
G : UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
H : SET GLOBAL PHANTOM  
J : NAME STYLE(Type+Num)  
L : SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT  
M : SET INHIBIT TABLE  
_
O
O
O
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
4095  
4095  
O
2800  
O
2800  
O
_
O
_
512  
512  
512  
1024  
4
1024  
1024  
2048  
255  
O
1024  
1024  
2048  
255  
O
_
512  
N : SET DESCRIPTION NAME  
O : SET TIE LINES  
_
1024  
_
4
P : CHANGE PASSWORD  
Q : CHANGE CROSSPOINT  
R : CALL SECONDARY STATION  
S : SET SOURCE ASSIGNMENT  
T : SET CLOCK  
O
1
O
O
8
8
8
8
O
_
O
O
O
O
_
_
O
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
U : SELECT CONTROL MODE  
W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG  
X : DISPLAY S-BUS COMMUNICATION  
Z : SET UNIT DETECTABLE  
A : SET UNIT LOCATION  
3
1
1
1
O
O
_
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
512  
T
_
512 (1024)  
512  
T
_
1024  
O
1024  
O
K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
M : SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
Includes the following models.  
T
O
O
_
(*1) DVS-V1616, BVS-A3232, BVS-V3232, DVS-TC3232, DVS-RS1616  
(*2) DVS-V3232B/V3232M  
(*3) HDS-X3400/X3600/X3700  
The CPU performance is the relative value when the DVS-V6464B is taken as the standard value 1.  
The models to which triangle mark T is set in the RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE, the mark indicates that it is partially  
initialized.  
The TIE LINES function of 4 and that of 255 have the different structure and different functions.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Functions and Menu Items  
Function  
Purpose  
Menu item  
Station type  
Standard setting  
Initializing table data  
Set/change password  
Set time clock  
K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
P : CHANGE PASSWORD  
T : SET CLOCK  
Primary station  
Select warning display ON/OFF  
Set type name  
V : SELECT WARNING DISPLAY  
B : SET SOURCE/DEST TYPE  
J : NAME STYLE  
Select input/output name style  
Set destination name  
Set source name  
C : SET DESTINATION NAME  
D : SET SOURCE NAME  
Set description name group  
Set level table  
N : SET DESCRIPTION NAME GROUP  
E : SET LEVEL TABLE  
Set active unit number  
F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
Copy main CPU data to backup CPU G : UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER  
Set physical assignment  
Call secondary station  
Set unit location  
L : SET PHYSICAL ASSIGNMENT  
R : CALL SECONDARY STATION  
A : SET UNIT LOCATION  
Secondary  
Copy main CPU data to backup CPU G : UPDATE BACKUP CONTROLLER station (switcher)  
Copy table data  
L : COPY TABLE DATA  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS  
N : SET PANEL TABLE  
Secondary  
station  
Set panel status  
Set panel table  
(remote control  
Set available destination style  
O : SET AVAILABLE DESTINATION unit)  
Crosspoint disable setting function  
Global phantom function  
M : SET INHIBIT TABLE  
Primary station  
H : SET GLOBAL PHANTOM  
H : SET PHANTOM TABLE  
Primary station  
Local phantom  
function  
Set phantom function  
Secondary  
station  
Protect function  
Secret function  
Set protect function  
Set secret function  
C : SET DESTINATION NAME  
D: SET SOURCE NAME  
Primary station  
Primary station  
Primary station  
Primary station  
Primary station  
Tie line management Set tie line system  
O : SET TIE LINES  
RS-422A  
Select RS-422A control mode  
U : SELECT CONTROL MODE  
R : CALL SECONDARY STATION  
U : SELECT REMOTE PROTOCOL  
9-pin remote control Call secondary station  
Select 9-pin remote protocol  
Secondary  
station  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
A-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Function  
Purpose  
Menu item  
Station type  
Monitor function  
Call secondary station  
R : CALL SECONDARY STATION  
Primary station  
Call primary station on monitor S-BUS M : SET MONITOR FUNCTION  
Secondary  
station  
Set active unit number  
Select monitor mode  
F : SET ACTIVE UNIT NUMBER  
Monitor S-BUS  
primary station  
M : SELECT MONITOR FUNCTION  
Call secondary station on monitor S-BUS R : CALL SECONDARY STATION  
Set available monitor unit  
Set panel table  
M : SET AVAILABLE MONITOR LINE Monitor S-BUS  
N : SET PANEL TABLE  
secondary  
station  
Copy table data  
L : COPY TABLE DATA  
Display Description name  
Set panel status  
S : DISPLAY DESCRIPTION NAME  
Z : SET PANEL STATUS  
Others  
Display control area  
Change crosspoint  
A : DISPLAY CONTROL AREA  
Q : CHANGE CROSSPOINT  
S : SELECT INDICATION COLOR  
W : SYSTEM STATUS LOG  
X : DISPLAY S-BUS COMMUNICATION  
Y : DISPLAY TABLE DATA  
Z : SET UNIT DETECTABLE  
K : RESET TO DEFAULT TABLE  
V : DISPLAY UNIT STATUS  
Y : DISPLAY TABLE DATA  
Z : SELECT SDI FORMAT  
Primary station  
Select indication color  
Display system status log  
Display S-BUS communication  
Display table data  
Set unit detectable  
Reset table data to default  
Display unit status  
Secondary  
station  
Display table data  
Select SDI format  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
A-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The material contained in this manual consists of  
information that is the property of Sony Corporation.  
Sony Corporation expressly prohibits the duplication of  
any portion of this manual or the use thereof for any  
purpose other than the operation or maintenance of the  
equipment described in this manual without the express  
written permission of Sony Corporation.  
Le matériel contenu dans ce manuel consiste en  
informations qui sont la propriété de Sony Corporation.  
Sony Corporation interdit formellement la copie de  
quelque partie que ce soit de ce manuel ou son emploi  
pour tout autre but que des opérations ou entretiens de  
l’équipement à moins d’une permission écrite de Sony  
Corporation.  
Das in dieser Anleitung enthaltene Material besteht aus  
Informationen, die Eigentum der Sony Corporation sind.  
Die Sony Corporation untersagt ausdrücklich die  
Vervielfältigung jeglicher Teile dieser Anleitung oder den  
Gebrauch derselben für irgendeinen anderen Zweck als  
die Bedienung oder Wartung der in dieser Anleitung  
beschriebenen  
Ausrüstung  
ohne  
ausdrückliche  
schriftliche Erlaubnis der Sony Corporation.  
ROUTING SWITCHER SYSTEM (E)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BVS-A3232 (SY)  
BVS-V3232 (SY)  
DVS-128 (SY)  
DVS-A3232 (EK)  
DVS-RS1616 (SY)  
DVS-TC3232 (SY)  
DVS-V1616 (SY)  
DVS-V3232B (SY)  
DVS-V3232M (SY)  
DVS-V6464B (SY)  
DVS-V6464M (SY)  
HDS-X3400 (SY)  
HDS-X3600 (SY)  
HDS-X3700 (SY)  
HDS-V3232 (JN) E  
3-194-351-06  
Printed in Japan  
2000. 7 16  
©1997  
Sony Corporation  
Communication System Solutions Network Company  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Sharp Microwave Oven R 231F User Manual
Shure Microphone VP User Manual
Silvercrest Toaster 800 A1 User Manual
Singer Sewing Machine CG 590 User Manual
Snell Acoustics Speaker 730 770 830 870 User Manual
Sony Clock Radio SY ICF C8WM User Manual
Sony Cordless Telephone SPP A1070 User Manual
Sony Stereo Receiver 3 289 450 451 User Manual
Sprint Nextel Network Router MiFi User Manual
Stanton CD Player S 700 User Manual